1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include <algorithm>
38 #include <cstdlib>
39 
40 using namespace clang;
41 using namespace sema;
42 
43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit;
44 
45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
46   return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
47     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
48   });
49 }
50 
51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
52 static ExprResult
53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
54                       const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
55                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
56                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
57   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
58     return ExprError();
59   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
60   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
61   // called on both.
62   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
63   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
64   // being used.
65   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
66     return ExprError();
67   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context)
68       DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
69   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
70     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
71 
72   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base);
73   if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
74     if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) {
75       S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
76       DRE->setType(Fn->getType());
77     }
78   }
79   return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()),
80                              CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
81 }
82 
83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
84                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
85                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
86                                  bool CStyle,
87                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
88 
89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
90                                                  QualType &ToType,
91                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
92                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
93                                                  bool CStyle);
94 static OverloadingResult
95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
96                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
97                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
98                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
99                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
100 
101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
103                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
104                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
105 
106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
108                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
109                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
110 
111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
113                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
114                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
115 
116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
119   static const ImplicitConversionRank
120     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
121     ICR_Exact_Match,
122     ICR_Exact_Match,
123     ICR_Exact_Match,
124     ICR_Exact_Match,
125     ICR_Exact_Match,
126     ICR_Exact_Match,
127     ICR_Promotion,
128     ICR_Promotion,
129     ICR_Promotion,
130     ICR_Conversion,
131     ICR_Conversion,
132     ICR_Conversion,
133     ICR_Conversion,
134     ICR_Conversion,
135     ICR_Conversion,
136     ICR_Conversion,
137     ICR_Conversion,
138     ICR_Conversion,
139     ICR_Conversion,
140     ICR_Conversion,
141     ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening,
142     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
143     ICR_Conversion,
144     ICR_Conversion,
145     ICR_Writeback_Conversion,
146     ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right --
147                      // it was omitted by the patch that added
148                      // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion
149     ICR_C_Conversion,
150     ICR_C_Conversion_Extension
151   };
152   return Rank[(int)Kind];
153 }
154 
155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
156 /// implicit conversion.
157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
158   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
159     "No conversion",
160     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
161     "Array-to-pointer",
162     "Function-to-pointer",
163     "Function pointer conversion",
164     "Qualification",
165     "Integral promotion",
166     "Floating point promotion",
167     "Complex promotion",
168     "Integral conversion",
169     "Floating conversion",
170     "Complex conversion",
171     "Floating-integral conversion",
172     "Pointer conversion",
173     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
174     "Boolean conversion",
175     "Compatible-types conversion",
176     "Derived-to-base conversion",
177     "Vector conversion",
178     "SVE Vector conversion",
179     "Vector splat",
180     "Complex-real conversion",
181     "Block Pointer conversion",
182     "Transparent Union Conversion",
183     "Writeback conversion",
184     "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion",
185     "C specific type conversion",
186     "Incompatible pointer conversion"
187   };
188   return Name[Kind];
189 }
190 
191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
192 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
194   First = ICK_Identity;
195   Second = ICK_Identity;
196   Third = ICK_Identity;
197   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
198   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
199   ReferenceBinding = false;
200   DirectBinding = false;
201   IsLvalueReference = true;
202   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
203   BindsToRvalue = false;
204   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
205   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
206   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
207 }
208 
209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
211 /// implicit conversions.
212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
213   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
214   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
215     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
216   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
217     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
218   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
219     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
220   return Rank;
221 }
222 
223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
228   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
229   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
230   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
231   // a pointer.
232   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
233       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
234        getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() ||
235        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
237        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
238     return true;
239 
240   return false;
241 }
242 
243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
246 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
247 bool
248 StandardConversionSequence::
249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
250   QualType FromType = getFromType();
251   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
252 
253   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
254   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
255   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
256   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
257     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
258 
259   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
260     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
261       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
262 
263   return false;
264 }
265 
266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx,
269                                              const Expr *Converted) {
270   // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be
271   // preserved so that destructors run if necessary.
272   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) {
273     Expr *Inner =
274         const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr()));
275     return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(),
276                                     EWC->getObjects());
277   }
278 
279   while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
280     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
281     case CK_NoOp:
282     case CK_IntegralCast:
283     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
284     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
285     case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral:
286     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
287     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
288     case CK_FloatingCast:
289       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
290       continue;
291 
292     default:
293       return Converted;
294     }
295   }
296 
297   return Converted;
298 }
299 
300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
302 ///
303 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
304 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
305 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
306 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
307 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions
310 ///        from floating point types to integral types should be ignored.
311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(
312     ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue,
313     QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const {
314   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
315 
316   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
317   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
318   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
319   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
320 
321   // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to
322   // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of
323   // the form 'Enum{init}'.
324   if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>())
325     ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
326 
327   switch (Second) {
328   // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it.
329   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
330     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType())
331       goto FloatingIntegralConversion;
332     if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
333       goto IntegralConversion;
334     // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or
335     return NK_Type_Narrowing;
336 
337   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
338   //
339   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
340   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
341   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
342   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
343   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
344   FloatingIntegralConversion:
345     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
346       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
347     } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
348                ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
349       if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion)
350         return NK_Not_Narrowing;
351       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
352       assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression");
353 
354       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
355       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
356         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
357 
358       if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue =
359               Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) {
360         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
361         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
362         Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(),
363                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
364         // And back.
365         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue;
366         bool ignored;
367         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
368                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
369         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
370         if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
371           ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue);
372           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
373           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
374         }
375       } else {
376         // Variables are always narrowings.
377         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
378       }
379     }
380     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
381 
382   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
383   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
384   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
385   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
386   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
387     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
388         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
389       // FromType is larger than ToType.
390       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
391 
392       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
393       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
394         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
395 
396       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
397         // Constant!
398         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
399         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
400         // Convert the source value into the target type.
401         bool ignored;
402         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
403           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
404           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
405         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
406         // values that can be represented.
407         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
408           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
409           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
410         }
411       } else {
412         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
413       }
414     }
415     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 
417   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
418   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
419   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
420   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
421   //    value when converted back to the original type.
422   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
423   IntegralConversion: {
424     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
425     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
426     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
427     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
428     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
429     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
430 
431     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
432         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
433         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
434       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
435       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
436 
437       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
438       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
439         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
440 
441       Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue;
442       if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) {
443         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
444         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
445       }
446       llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue;
447       bool Narrowing = false;
448       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
449         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
450         // narrowing.
451         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
452           Narrowing = true;
453       } else {
454         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
455         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
456         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
457           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
458         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
459         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
460         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
461         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
462         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
463         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
464         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
465         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
466           Narrowing = true;
467       }
468       if (Narrowing) {
469         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
470         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
471         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
472       }
473     }
474     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
475   }
476 
477   default:
478     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
479     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
480   }
481 }
482 
483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
486   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
487   bool PrintedSomething = false;
488   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
489     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
490     PrintedSomething = true;
491   }
492 
493   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
494     if (PrintedSomething) {
495       OS << " -> ";
496     }
497     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
498 
499     if (CopyConstructor) {
500       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
501     } else if (DirectBinding) {
502       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
503     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
504       OS << " (reference binding)";
505     }
506     PrintedSomething = true;
507   }
508 
509   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
510     if (PrintedSomething) {
511       OS << " -> ";
512     }
513     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
514     PrintedSomething = true;
515   }
516 
517   if (!PrintedSomething) {
518     OS << "No conversions required";
519   }
520 }
521 
522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
525   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
526   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
527     Before.dump();
528     OS << " -> ";
529   }
530   if (ConversionFunction)
531     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
532   else
533     OS << "aggregate initialization";
534   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
535     OS << " -> ";
536     After.dump();
537   }
538 }
539 
540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
543   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
544   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
545     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
546   switch (ConversionKind) {
547   case StandardConversion:
548     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
549     Standard.dump();
550     break;
551   case UserDefinedConversion:
552     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
553     UserDefined.dump();
554     break;
555   case EllipsisConversion:
556     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
557     break;
558   case AmbiguousConversion:
559     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
560     break;
561   case BadConversion:
562     OS << "Bad conversion";
563     break;
564   }
565 
566   OS << "\n";
567 }
568 
569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
570   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
571 }
572 
573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
574   conversions().~ConversionSet();
575 }
576 
577 void
578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
579   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
580   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
581   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
582 }
583 
584 namespace {
585   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
586   // template argument information.
587   struct DFIArguments {
588     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
589     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
590   };
591   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
592   // template parameter and template argument information.
593   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
594     TemplateParameter Param;
595   };
596   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument
597   // information and the index of the problematic call argument.
598   struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments {
599     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
600     unsigned CallArgIndex;
601   };
602   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about
603   // unsatisfied constraints.
604   struct CNSInfo {
605     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
606     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
607   };
608 }
609 
610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
612 DeductionFailureInfo
613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
614                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
615                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
616   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
617   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
618   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
619   switch (TDK) {
620   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
621   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
622   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
623   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
624   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
625   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
626     Result.Data = nullptr;
627     break;
628 
629   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
630   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
631     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
632     break;
633 
634   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
635   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
636     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
637     auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs;
638     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
639     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
640     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
641     Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex;
642     Result.Data = Saved;
643     break;
644   }
645 
646   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
647     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
648     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
649     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
650     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
651     Result.Data = Saved;
652     break;
653   }
654 
655   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
656     // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this.
657   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
658   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
659     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
660     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
661     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
662     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
663     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
664     Result.Data = Saved;
665     break;
666   }
667 
668   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
669     Result.Data = Info.take();
670     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
671       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
672           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
673       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
674       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
675     }
676     break;
677 
678   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
679     CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo;
680     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
681     Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction;
682     Result.Data = Saved;
683     break;
684   }
685 
686   case Sema::TDK_Success:
687   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
688     llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure");
689   }
690 
691   return Result;
692 }
693 
694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
695   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
696   case Sema::TDK_Success:
697   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
698   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
699   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
700   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
701   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
702   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
703   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
704   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
705     break;
706 
707   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
708   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
709   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
710   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
711   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
712   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
713     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
714     Data = nullptr;
715     break;
716 
717   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
718     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
719     Data = nullptr;
720     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
721       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
722       HasDiagnostic = false;
723     }
724     break;
725 
726   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
727     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
728     Data = nullptr;
729     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
730       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
731       HasDiagnostic = false;
732     }
733     break;
734 
735   // Unhandled
736   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
737     break;
738   }
739 }
740 
741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
742   if (HasDiagnostic)
743     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
744   return nullptr;
745 }
746 
747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
748   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
749   case Sema::TDK_Success:
750   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
751   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
752   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
753   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
754   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
755   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
756   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
757   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
758   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
759   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
760   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
761     return TemplateParameter();
762 
763   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
764   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
765     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
766 
767   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
768   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
769   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
770     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
771 
772   // Unhandled
773   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
774     break;
775   }
776 
777   return TemplateParameter();
778 }
779 
780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
781   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
782   case Sema::TDK_Success:
783   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
784   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
785   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
786   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
787   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
788   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
789   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
790   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
791   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
792   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
793   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
794   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
795     return nullptr;
796 
797   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
798   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
799     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
800 
801   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
802     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
803 
804   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
805     return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
806 
807   // Unhandled
808   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
809     break;
810   }
811 
812   return nullptr;
813 }
814 
815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
816   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
817   case Sema::TDK_Success:
818   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
819   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
820   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
821   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
822   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
823   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
824   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
825   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
826   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
827   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
828     return nullptr;
829 
830   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
831   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
832   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
833   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
834   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
835   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
836     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
837 
838   // Unhandled
839   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
840     break;
841   }
842 
843   return nullptr;
844 }
845 
846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
847   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
848   case Sema::TDK_Success:
849   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
850   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
851   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
852   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
853   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
854   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
855   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
856   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
857   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
858   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
859   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
860     return nullptr;
861 
862   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
863   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
864   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
865   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
866   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
867     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
868 
869   // Unhandled
870   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
871     break;
872   }
873 
874   return nullptr;
875 }
876 
877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() {
878   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
879   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
880   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
881     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex;
882 
883   default:
884     return llvm::None;
885   }
886 }
887 
888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
889     OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
890   if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates)
891     return false;
892   return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship;
893 }
894 
895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
896     ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
897   if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator()))
898     return false;
899   // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better
900   // match than the non-reversed version.
901   return FD->getNumParams() != 2 ||
902          !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(),
903                                      FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) ||
904          FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
905 }
906 
907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
908   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
909     for (auto &C : i->Conversions)
910       C.~ImplicitConversionSequence();
911     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
912       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
913   }
914 }
915 
916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) {
917   destroyCandidates();
918   SlabAllocator.Reset();
919   NumInlineBytesUsed = 0;
920   Candidates.clear();
921   Functions.clear();
922   Kind = CSK;
923 }
924 
925 namespace {
926   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
927     struct Entry {
928       Expr **Addr;
929       Expr *Saved;
930     };
931     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
932 
933   public:
934     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
935       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
936       Entry entry = { &E, E };
937       Entries.push_back(entry);
938       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
939     }
940 
941     void restore() {
942       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
943              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
944         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
945     }
946   };
947 }
948 
949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
950 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
951 ///
952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
953 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
954 ///
955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
956 static bool
957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
958                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
959   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
960     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
961     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
962     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
963 
964     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
965     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
966     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
967         unbridgedCasts) {
968       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
969       return false;
970     }
971 
972     // Go ahead and check everything else.
973     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
974     if (result.isInvalid())
975       return true;
976 
977     E = result.get();
978     return false;
979   }
980 
981   // Nothing to do.
982   return false;
983 }
984 
985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
986 /// placeholders.
987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
988                                             MultiExprArg Args,
989                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
990   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
991     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
992       return true;
993 
994   return false;
995 }
996 
997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the
998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if
999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as
1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't
1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or
1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be
1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying
1004 /// declaration.
1005 ///
1006 /// Example: Given the following input:
1007 ///
1008 ///   void f(int, float); // #1
1009 ///   void f(int, int); // #2
1010 ///   int f(int, int); // #3
1011 ///
1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload
1013 /// will not be used.
1014 ///
1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing
1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have
1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is
1018 /// unchanged.
1019 ///
1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare
1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then
1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of
1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and
1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
1025 ///
1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class
1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations
1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's
1029 /// signature.
1030 Sema::OverloadKind
1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
1032                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
1033   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
1034          I != E; ++I) {
1035     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
1036 
1037     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
1038     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
1039       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
1040 
1041       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
1042       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
1043       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
1044 
1045       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
1046     }
1047 
1048     // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration
1049     // if one of them is hidden.
1050     if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I))
1051       continue;
1052 
1053     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
1054     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
1055     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
1056     // function templates hide function templates with different
1057     // return types or template parameter lists.
1058     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
1059       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
1060       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
1061 
1062     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
1063       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
1064         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
1065           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
1066           continue;
1067         }
1068 
1069         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
1070             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
1071           continue;
1072 
1073         Match = *I;
1074         return Ovl_Match;
1075       }
1076 
1077       // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should
1078       // not be overloadable or redeclarable.
1079       if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) {
1080         Match = *I;
1081         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1082       }
1083     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) {
1084       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
1085       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
1086       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
1087     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
1088       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
1089     } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
1090       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
1091       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
1092       // template instantiation.
1093       //
1094       // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class
1095       // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator.
1096       if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) {
1097         Match = *I;
1098         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1099       }
1100     } else {
1101       // (C++ 13p1):
1102       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
1103       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
1104       Match = *I;
1105       return Ovl_NonFunction;
1106     }
1107   }
1108 
1109   // C++ [temp.friend]p1:
1110   //   For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration:
1111   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id,
1112   //       [...], otherwise
1113   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching
1114   //       non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace,
1115   //       the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise,
1116   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function
1117   //       template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend
1118   //       declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function
1119   //       template, otherwise
1120   //    -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...]
1121   // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the
1122   // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup
1123   // until instantiation.
1124   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() &&
1125       !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
1126       !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() &&
1127       !New->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1128     LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old);
1129     TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old);
1130     if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult,
1131                                             /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) {
1132       New->setInvalidDecl();
1133       return Ovl_Overload;
1134     }
1135 
1136     Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>();
1137     return Ovl_Match;
1138   }
1139 
1140   return Ovl_Overload;
1141 }
1142 
1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1144                       bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs,
1145                       bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1146   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
1147   if (New->isMain())
1148     return false;
1149 
1150   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
1151   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
1152     return false;
1153 
1154   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1155   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1156 
1157   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
1158   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
1159   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
1160   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
1161     return true;
1162 
1163   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
1164   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
1165   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
1166 
1167   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1168   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1169   // in the signature, they are overloads.
1170 
1171   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1172   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1173   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1174       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1175     return false;
1176 
1177   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1178   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
1179 
1180   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1181   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1182   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1183   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1184       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
1185        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
1186        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
1187     return true;
1188 
1189   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1190   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1191   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1192   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1193   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1194   //   signature.
1195   //
1196   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1197   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1198   //
1199   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1200   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1201   if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1202       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1203                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1204                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1205        !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(),
1206                             New->getDeclaredReturnType())))
1207     return true;
1208 
1209   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1210   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1211   //
1212   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1213   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1214   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1215   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1216   // can be overloaded.
1217   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1218   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1219   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1220       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1221     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1222       if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules &&
1223           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1224            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1225         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1226         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1227         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1228         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1229         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1230         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1231         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1232           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1233         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1234       }
1235       return true;
1236     }
1237 
1238     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1239     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1240     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1241     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1242     auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1243     auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1244     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1245         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1246       NewQuals.addConst();
1247     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1248     OldQuals.removeRestrict();
1249     NewQuals.removeRestrict();
1250     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1251       return true;
1252   }
1253 
1254   // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we
1255   // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function
1256   // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with
1257   // pass_object_size or it doesn't.
1258   if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) !=
1259       functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old))
1260     return true;
1261 
1262   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1263   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1264          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1265          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1266          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1267          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1268        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1269     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1270       return true;
1271     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1272     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1273     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1274     if (NewID != OldID)
1275       return true;
1276   }
1277 
1278   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) {
1279     // Don't allow overloading of destructors.  (In theory we could, but it
1280     // would be a giant change to clang.)
1281     if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) {
1282       CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New),
1283                          OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old);
1284       if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) {
1285         assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) &&
1286                "Unexpected invalid target.");
1287 
1288         // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA
1289         // target attributes.
1290         if (NewTarget != OldTarget)
1291           return true;
1292       }
1293     }
1294   }
1295 
1296   if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1297     Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(),
1298          *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause();
1299     if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr))
1300       // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads.
1301       return true;
1302 
1303     if (NewRC) {
1304       llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1305       NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1306       OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1307       if (NewID != OldID)
1308         // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads.
1309         return true;
1310     }
1311   }
1312 
1313   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1314   return false;
1315 }
1316 
1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1318 ///
1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1323                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1324                          AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1325                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1326                          bool CStyle,
1327                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1328                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1329   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1330 
1331   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1332     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1333     // we can perform.
1334     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1335     return ICS;
1336   }
1337 
1338   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1339   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1340                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1341   switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
1342                                   Conversions, AllowExplicit,
1343                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) {
1344   case OR_Success:
1345   case OR_Deleted:
1346     ICS.setUserDefined();
1347     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1348     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1349     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1350     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1351     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1352     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1353     //   called for those cases.
1354     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1355           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1356       QualType FromCanon
1357         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1358       QualType ToCanon
1359         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1360       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1361           (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
1362            S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1363         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1364         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1365         DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction;
1366         ICS.setStandard();
1367         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1368         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1369         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1370         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1371         ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found;
1372         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1373           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1374       }
1375     }
1376     break;
1377 
1378   case OR_Ambiguous:
1379     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1380     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1381     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1382     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1383          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1384       if (Cand->Best)
1385         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
1386     break;
1387 
1388     // Fall through.
1389   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
1390     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1391     break;
1392   }
1393 
1394   return ICS;
1395 }
1396 
1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1401 ///
1402 ///   void f(float f);
1403 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1404 ///
1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1409 //
1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1414 /// "BadConversion".
1415 ///
1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1417 /// not permitted.
1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1419 /// permitted.
1420 ///
1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1426                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1427                       AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1428                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1429                       bool CStyle,
1430                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1431                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1432   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1433   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1434                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1435     ICS.setStandard();
1436     return ICS;
1437   }
1438 
1439   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1440     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1441     return ICS;
1442   }
1443 
1444   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1445   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1446   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1447   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1448   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1449   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1450   //   called for those cases.
1451   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1452   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1453       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1454        S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) {
1455     ICS.setStandard();
1456     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1457     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1458     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1459 
1460     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1461     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1462     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1463     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1464     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1465 
1466     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1467     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1468       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1469 
1470     return ICS;
1471   }
1472 
1473   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1474                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1475                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1476                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1477 }
1478 
1479 ImplicitConversionSequence
1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1481                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1482                             AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1483                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1484                             bool CStyle,
1485                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1486   return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1487                                  AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1488                                  AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1489                                  /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1490 }
1491 
1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1498                                            AssignmentAction Action,
1499                                            bool AllowExplicit) {
1500   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1501     return ExprError();
1502 
1503   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1504   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1505     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1506       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1507   if (getLangOpts().ObjC)
1508     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
1509                                       From->getType(), From);
1510   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(
1511       *this, From, ToType,
1512       /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1513       AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None,
1514       /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1515       /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1516       /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1517   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1518 }
1519 
1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function
1522 /// type.
1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1524                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1525   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1526     return false;
1527 
1528   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1529   //                    or F(t noexcept) -> F(t)
1530   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1531   //   - a pointer
1532   //   - a member pointer
1533   //   - a block pointer
1534   // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType.
1535   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1536   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1537   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1538   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1539   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1540     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1541       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1542       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1543     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1544       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1545       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1546     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1547       auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1548       auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1549       // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function.
1550       if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass())
1551         return false;
1552       CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType();
1553       CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType();
1554     } else {
1555       return false;
1556     }
1557 
1558     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1559     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1560     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1561       return false;
1562   }
1563 
1564   const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1565   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1566 
1567   const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo);
1568   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo();
1569 
1570   bool Changed = false;
1571 
1572   // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type.
1573   if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) {
1574     FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1575     Changed = true;
1576   }
1577 
1578   // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type.
1579   if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) {
1580     const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn);
1581     if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) {
1582       FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(
1583           Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0),
1584                                                    EST_None)
1585                  .getTypePtr());
1586       Changed = true;
1587     }
1588 
1589     // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid
1590     // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be
1591     // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list.
1592     SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
1593     bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
1594     if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT,
1595                                       CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) &&
1596         CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) {
1597       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo();
1598       ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos =
1599           NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data();
1600       QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(),
1601                                             FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo);
1602       FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>();
1603       Changed = true;
1604     }
1605   }
1606 
1607   if (!Changed)
1608     return false;
1609 
1610   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1611   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1612 
1613   ResultTy = ToType;
1614   return true;
1615 }
1616 
1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1618 /// vector conversion.
1619 ///
1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1621 /// conversion.
1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1623                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1624   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1625   // conversion.
1626   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1627     return false;
1628 
1629   // Identical types require no conversions.
1630   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1631     return false;
1632 
1633   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1634   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1635     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1636     // identity conversion.
1637     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1638       return false;
1639 
1640     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1641     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1642       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1643       return true;
1644     }
1645   }
1646 
1647   if (ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType())
1648     if (S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1649         S.Context.areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
1650       ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion;
1651       return true;
1652     }
1653 
1654   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1655   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1656   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1657   //   same size
1658   // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism
1659   //   attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution
1660   //   only
1661   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1662     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1663         (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) &&
1664          !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) {
1665       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1666       return true;
1667     }
1668   }
1669 
1670   return false;
1671 }
1672 
1673 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1674                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1675                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1676                                 bool CStyle);
1677 
1678 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1679 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1680 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1681 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1682 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1683 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1684 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1685 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1686 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1687                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1688                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1689                                  bool CStyle,
1690                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1691   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1692 
1693   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1694   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1695   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1696   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1697   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1698 
1699   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1700   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them.
1701   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1702       (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()))
1703     return false;
1704 
1705   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1706   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1707   // (C++ 4p1).
1708 
1709   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1710     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1711     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1712           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1713                                                  AccessPair)) {
1714       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1715       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1716       FromType = Fn->getType();
1717       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1718 
1719       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1720       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1721       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1722                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1723         QualType resultTy;
1724         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1725         if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType,
1726               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1727           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1728           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1729             return false;
1730       }
1731 
1732       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1733       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1734       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1735       // expression.
1736       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1737       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1738         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1739                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1740         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1741                == UO_AddrOf &&
1742                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1743         const Type *ClassType
1744           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1745         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1746       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1747         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1748                UO_AddrOf &&
1749                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1750         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1751       }
1752 
1753       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1754       // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't
1755       // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block.
1756       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1757         FromType,
1758         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1759     } else {
1760       return false;
1761     }
1762   }
1763   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1764   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1765   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1766   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1767   if (argIsLValue &&
1768       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1769       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1770     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1771 
1772     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1773     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1774     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1775     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1776       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1777 
1778     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1779     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1780     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1781     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1782     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1783   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1784     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1785     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1786 
1787     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1788     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1789     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1790     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1791 
1792     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1793       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1794       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1795 
1796       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1797       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1798       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1799       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1800       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1801       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1802       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1803       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1804       return true;
1805     }
1806   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1807     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1808     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1809 
1810     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts()))
1811       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
1812         if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
1813           return false;
1814 
1815     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1816     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1817     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1818     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1819   } else {
1820     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1821     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1822   }
1823   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1824 
1825   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1826   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1827   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1828   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1829   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1830   // conversion.
1831   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1832   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1833   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1834     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1835     // conversion to do.
1836     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1837   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1838     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1839     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1840     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1841   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1842     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1843     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1844     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1845   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1846     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1847     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1848     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1849   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1850              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1851               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1852               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1853               FromType->isMemberPointerType())) {
1854     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1855     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1856     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1857   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1858              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1859     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1860     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1861     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1862   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1863     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1864     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1865     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1866   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1867              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1868     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1869     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1870     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1871   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1872     // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if
1873     // their representation is different until there is back end support
1874     // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double.
1875 
1876     // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted.
1877     if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty)
1878       return false;
1879     if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) !=
1880         &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) {
1881       bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty &&
1882                                     ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ||
1883                                    (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy &&
1884                                     ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty));
1885       if (Float128AndLongDouble &&
1886           (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ==
1887            &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()))
1888         return false;
1889     }
1890     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1891     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1892     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1893   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1894               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1895              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1896               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1897     // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted.
1898     if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type())
1899       return false;
1900 
1901     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1902     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1903     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1904   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1905     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1906   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1907              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1908     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1909   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1910                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1911     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1912     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1913     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1914     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1915   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1916                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1917     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1918     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1919   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1920     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1921     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1922   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1923              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1924     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1925     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1926     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1927   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1928                                              InOverloadResolution,
1929                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1930     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1931     FromType = ToType;
1932   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1933                                  CStyle)) {
1934     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1935     // appropriately.
1936     return true;
1937   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1938              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1939              From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) {
1940     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1941     FromType = ToType;
1942   } else if (ToType->isQueueT() &&
1943              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1944              (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1945     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion;
1946     FromType = ToType;
1947   } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() &&
1948              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) {
1949     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1950     FromType = ToType;
1951   } else {
1952     // No second conversion required.
1953     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1954   }
1955   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1956 
1957   // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a
1958   // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]).
1959   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1960   if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1961     // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of
1962     // 'noreturn' (Clang extension).
1963     SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion;
1964   } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1965                                          ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1966     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1967     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1968     FromType = ToType;
1969   } else {
1970     // No conversion required
1971     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1972   }
1973 
1974   // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1975   //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1976   //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1977   //   a conversion. [...]
1978   QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1979   QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1980   if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1981                                      == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1982       CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1983     FromType = ToType;
1984     CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1985   }
1986 
1987   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1988 
1989   if (CanonFrom == CanonTo)
1990     return true;
1991 
1992   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1993   // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C.
1994   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution)
1995     return false;
1996 
1997   ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From};
1998   Sema::AssignConvertType Conv =
1999       S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER,
2000                                          /*Diagnose=*/false,
2001                                          /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false,
2002                                          /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
2003   ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv;
2004   switch (Conv) {
2005   case Sema::Compatible:
2006     SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
2007     break;
2008   // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an
2009   // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop
2010   // qualifiers, as well.
2011   case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
2012   case Sema::IncompatiblePointer:
2013   case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign:
2014     SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
2015     break;
2016   default:
2017     return false;
2018   }
2019 
2020   // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the
2021   // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the
2022   // function.
2023   SCS.Second = SecondConv;
2024   SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
2025 
2026   // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other
2027   // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just
2028   // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything
2029   // from making this ICK_Qualification.
2030   SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
2031   SCS.setToType(2, ToType);
2032   return true;
2033 }
2034 
2035 static bool
2036 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
2037                                      QualType &ToType,
2038                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2039                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2040                                      bool CStyle) {
2041 
2042   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
2043   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
2044     return false;
2045   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
2046   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
2047   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
2048   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
2049     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
2050                              CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
2051       ToType = it->getType();
2052       return true;
2053     }
2054   }
2055   return false;
2056 }
2057 
2058 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
2059 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
2060 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
2061 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2062 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2063   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
2064   // All integers are built-in.
2065   if (!To) {
2066     return false;
2067   }
2068 
2069   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
2070   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
2071   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
2072   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
2073   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
2074   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
2075       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
2076     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
2077         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
2078          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
2079          // less than int to an int.
2080          Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) {
2081       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2082     }
2083 
2084     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2085   }
2086 
2087   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
2088   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
2089   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
2090   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
2091   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
2092   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
2093   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
2094   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
2095   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
2096   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
2097   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
2098   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
2099   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
2100   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
2101   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
2102   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
2103   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
2104   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
2105   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
2106     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
2107     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
2108     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
2109       return false;
2110 
2111     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
2112     // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting
2113     // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider
2114     // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression.
2115     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
2116       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2117       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
2118              IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType);
2119     }
2120 
2121     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
2122     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
2123         isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType))
2124       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2125           ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
2126 
2127     // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
2128     //   If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other
2129     //   value of that type for promotion purposes.
2130     //
2131     // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++.
2132     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2133       return false;
2134   }
2135 
2136   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
2137   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
2138   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
2139   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
2140   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
2141   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
2142   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
2143   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
2144   //   type.
2145   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
2146       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
2147     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
2148     // unsigned.
2149     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
2150     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
2151 
2152     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
2153     // order. Try each of these types.
2154     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
2155       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
2156       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
2157       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
2158     };
2159     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
2160       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2161       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
2162           (FromSize == ToSize &&
2163            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
2164         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
2165         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
2166         // promotion.
2167         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2168       }
2169     }
2170   }
2171 
2172   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
2173   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
2174   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
2175   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
2176   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
2177   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
2178   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
2179   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
2180   // conversion.
2181   //
2182   // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be
2183   // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum
2184   // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC
2185   // compatibility.
2186   if (From) {
2187     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
2188       Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth;
2189       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
2190           (BitWidth =
2191                MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
2192         llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned());
2193         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
2194 
2195         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
2196         if (*BitWidth < ToSize ||
2197             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
2198           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2199         }
2200 
2201         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
2202         // that fits into an unsigned int?
2203         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) {
2204           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2205         }
2206 
2207         return false;
2208       }
2209     }
2210   }
2211 
2212   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
2213   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
2214   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
2215     return true;
2216   }
2217 
2218   return false;
2219 }
2220 
2221 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
2222 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
2223 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2224 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2225   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
2226     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2227       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
2228       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
2229       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
2230           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
2231         return true;
2232 
2233       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
2234       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
2235       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
2236       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2237           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
2238            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
2239           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble ||
2240            ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))
2241         return true;
2242 
2243       // Half can be promoted to float.
2244       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
2245            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
2246           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
2247         return true;
2248     }
2249 
2250   return false;
2251 }
2252 
2253 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
2254 ///
2255 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
2256 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
2257 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
2258 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2259   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2260   if (!FromComplex)
2261     return false;
2262 
2263   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2264   if (!ToComplex)
2265     return false;
2266 
2267   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
2268                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
2269     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
2270                         ToComplex->getElementType());
2271 }
2272 
2273 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
2274 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
2275 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
2276 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
2277 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
2278 ///
2279 static QualType
2280 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
2281                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
2282                                    ASTContext &Context,
2283                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
2284   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
2285           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
2286          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
2287 
2288   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
2289   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
2290     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2291 
2292   QualType CanonFromPointee
2293     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
2294   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
2295   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
2296 
2297   if (StripObjCLifetime)
2298     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
2299 
2300   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
2301   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
2302     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
2303     if (!ToType.isNull())
2304       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2305 
2306     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
2307     // already.
2308     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2309       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
2310     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
2311   }
2312 
2313   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
2314   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
2315     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
2316 
2317   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2318     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2319   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2320 }
2321 
2322 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
2323                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2324                                                ASTContext &Context) {
2325   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
2326   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
2327   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
2328       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
2329     return !InOverloadResolution;
2330 
2331   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2332                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2333                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
2334 }
2335 
2336 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2337 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
2338 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
2339 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
2340 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
2341 /// ConvertedType.
2342 ///
2343 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2344 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2345 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2346 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2347 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2348 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
2349 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2350 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2351 /// should result in a warning.
2352 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2353                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2354                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2355                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2356   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2357   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2358                               IncompatibleObjC))
2359     return true;
2360 
2361   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2362   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2363       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2364     ConvertedType = ToType;
2365     return true;
2366   }
2367 
2368   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2369   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2370       ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2371     ConvertedType = ToType;
2372     return true;
2373   }
2374   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2375   // pointer type.
2376   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2377       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2378     ConvertedType = ToType;
2379     return true;
2380   }
2381 
2382   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2383   // pointer constant.
2384   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2385       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2386     ConvertedType = ToType;
2387     return true;
2388   }
2389 
2390   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2391   if (!ToTypePtr)
2392     return false;
2393 
2394   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2395   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2396     ConvertedType = ToType;
2397     return true;
2398   }
2399 
2400   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2401   // , including objective-c pointers.
2402   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2403   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2404       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2405     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2406                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2407                                                        ToPointeeType,
2408                                                        ToType, Context);
2409     return true;
2410   }
2411   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2412   if (!FromTypePtr)
2413     return false;
2414 
2415   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2416 
2417   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2418   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2419   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2420     return false;
2421 
2422   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2423   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2424   // 4.10p2).
2425   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2426       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2427     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2428                                                        ToPointeeType,
2429                                                        ToType, Context,
2430                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2431     return true;
2432   }
2433 
2434   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2435   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2436       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2437     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2438                                                        ToPointeeType,
2439                                                        ToType, Context);
2440     return true;
2441   }
2442 
2443   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2444   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2445   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2446       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2447     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2448                                                        ToPointeeType,
2449                                                        ToType, Context);
2450     return true;
2451   }
2452 
2453   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2454   //
2455   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2456   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2457   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2458   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2459   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2460   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2461   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2462   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2463   //
2464   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2465   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2466   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2467       ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2468       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2469       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2470     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2471                                                        ToPointeeType,
2472                                                        ToType, Context);
2473     return true;
2474   }
2475 
2476   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2477       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2478     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2479                                                        ToPointeeType,
2480                                                        ToType, Context);
2481     return true;
2482   }
2483 
2484   return false;
2485 }
2486 
2487 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2488 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2489   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2490 
2491   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2492   if (TQs == Qs)
2493     return T;
2494 
2495   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2496     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2497 
2498   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2499 }
2500 
2501 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2502 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2503 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2504 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2505                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2506                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2507   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC)
2508     return false;
2509 
2510   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2511   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2512 
2513   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2514   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2515     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2516   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2517     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2518 
2519   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2520     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2521     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2522     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2523                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2524       return false;
2525 
2526     // Conversion between Objective-C pointers.
2527     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2528       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2529       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2530       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2531           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2532                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2533         return false;
2534       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2535                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2536                                                          ToType, Context);
2537       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2538       return true;
2539     }
2540 
2541     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2542       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2543       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2544       // complain about it.
2545       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2546       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2547                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2548                                                          ToType, Context);
2549       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2550       return true;
2551     }
2552   }
2553   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2554   QualType ToPointeeType;
2555   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2556     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2557   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2558             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2559     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2560     // to a block pointer type.
2561     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2562       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2563       return true;
2564     }
2565     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2566   }
2567   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2568            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2569     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2570     // pointer to any object.
2571     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2572     return true;
2573   }
2574   else
2575     return false;
2576 
2577   QualType FromPointeeType;
2578   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2579     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2580   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2581            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2582     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2583   else
2584     return false;
2585 
2586   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2587   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2588   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2589       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2590                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2591     // We always complain about this conversion.
2592     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2593     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2594     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2595     return true;
2596   }
2597   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2598   // as in I* to id.
2599   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2600       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2601       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2602                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2603 
2604     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2605     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2606     return true;
2607   }
2608 
2609   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2610   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2611   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2612   // complain about it).
2613   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2614     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2615   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2616     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2617   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2618     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2619     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2620     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2621           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2622       return false;
2623 
2624     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2625     // function types are obviously different.
2626     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2627         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2628         FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals())
2629       return false;
2630 
2631     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2632     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2633         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2634       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2635     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2636                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2637                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2638       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2639       HasObjCConversion = true;
2640     } else {
2641       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2642       return false;
2643     }
2644 
2645     // Check argument types.
2646     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2647          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2648       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2649       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2650       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2651             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2652         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2653       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2654                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2655         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2656         HasObjCConversion = true;
2657       } else {
2658         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2659         return false;
2660       }
2661     }
2662 
2663     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2664       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2665       // conversion, but complain about it.
2666       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2667       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2668       return true;
2669     }
2670   }
2671 
2672   return false;
2673 }
2674 
2675 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2676 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2677 ///
2678 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2679 ///
2680 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2681 ///
2682 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2683 /// this conversion.
2684 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2685                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2686   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2687       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2688     return false;
2689 
2690   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2691   QualType ToPointee;
2692   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2693     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2694   else
2695     return false;
2696 
2697   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2698   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2699       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2700       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2701     return false;
2702 
2703   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2704   QualType FromPointee;
2705   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2706     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2707   else
2708     return false;
2709 
2710   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2711   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2712       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2713        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2714     return false;
2715 
2716   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2717   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2718   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2719     return false;
2720 
2721   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2722   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2723   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2724   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2725 
2726   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2727   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2728   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2729   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2730     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2731   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2732                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2733     return false;
2734 
2735   /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2736   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2737   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2738   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2739   return true;
2740 }
2741 
2742 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2743                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2744   QualType ToPointeeType;
2745   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2746         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2747     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2748   else
2749     return false;
2750 
2751   QualType FromPointeeType;
2752   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2753       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2754     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2755   else
2756     return false;
2757   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2758   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2759   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2760 
2761   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2762     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2763   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2764     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2765 
2766   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2767     return false;
2768 
2769   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2770     return true;
2771 
2772   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2773   // function types are obviously different.
2774   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2775       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2776     return false;
2777 
2778   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2779   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2780   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2781     return false;
2782 
2783   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2784   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2785                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2786     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2787   } else {
2788     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2789     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2790     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2791         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2792        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2793 
2794      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2795        // OK exact match.
2796      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2797                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2798      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2799        return false;
2800      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2801      }
2802      else
2803        return false;
2804    }
2805 
2806    // Check argument types.
2807    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2808         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2809      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2810      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2811      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2812      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2813        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2814      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2815                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2816        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2817          return false;
2818        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2819      } else
2820        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2821        return false;
2822    }
2823 
2824    SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
2825    bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
2826    if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType,
2827                                       CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT,
2828                                       NewParamInfos))
2829      return false;
2830 
2831    ConvertedType = ToType;
2832    return true;
2833 }
2834 
2835 enum {
2836   ft_default,
2837   ft_different_class,
2838   ft_parameter_arity,
2839   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2840   ft_return_type,
2841   ft_qualifer_mismatch,
2842   ft_noexcept
2843 };
2844 
2845 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles
2846 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly.
2847 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) {
2848   if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
2849     return FPT;
2850 
2851   if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
2852     return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2853 
2854   return nullptr;
2855 }
2856 
2857 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2858 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2859 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2860 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2861                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2862   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2863   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2864     PDiag << ft_default;
2865     return;
2866   }
2867 
2868   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2869   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2870     const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2871                *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
2872     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2873       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2874             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2875       return;
2876     }
2877     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2878     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2879   }
2880 
2881   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2882     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2883   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2884     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2885 
2886   // Remove references.
2887   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2888   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2889 
2890   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2891   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2892       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2893     PDiag << ft_default;
2894     return;
2895   }
2896 
2897   // No extra info for same types.
2898   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2899     PDiag << ft_default;
2900     return;
2901   }
2902 
2903   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType),
2904                           *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType);
2905 
2906   // Both types need to be function types.
2907   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2908     PDiag << ft_default;
2909     return;
2910   }
2911 
2912   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2913     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2914           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2915     return;
2916   }
2917 
2918   // Handle different parameter types.
2919   unsigned ArgPos;
2920   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2921     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2922           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2923           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2924     return;
2925   }
2926 
2927   // Handle different return type.
2928   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2929                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2930     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2931           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2932     return;
2933   }
2934 
2935   if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) {
2936     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals()
2937           << FromFunction->getMethodQuals();
2938     return;
2939   }
2940 
2941   // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17
2942   // onwards).
2943   if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2944           ->isNothrow() !=
2945       cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2946           ->isNothrow()) {
2947     PDiag << ft_noexcept;
2948     return;
2949   }
2950 
2951   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2952   PDiag << ft_default;
2953 }
2954 
2955 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2956 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2957 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2958 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2959 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2960                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2961                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2962   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2963                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2964                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2965        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2966     // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading
2967     // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces.
2968     QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType());
2969     QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType());
2970 
2971     if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) {
2972       if (ArgPos)
2973         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2974       return false;
2975     }
2976   }
2977   return true;
2978 }
2979 
2980 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2981 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2982 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2983 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2984 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2985 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2986 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2987                                   CastKind &Kind,
2988                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2989                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess,
2990                                   bool Diagnose) {
2991   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2992   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2993 
2994   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2995 
2996   if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2997       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2998           Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2999     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
3000       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
3001                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
3002                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
3003     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
3004       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
3005         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3006   }
3007   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3008     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3009       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
3010                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
3011 
3012       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
3013           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
3014         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
3015         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
3016         unsigned InaccessibleID = 0;
3017         unsigned AmbiguousID = 0;
3018         if (Diagnose) {
3019           InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base;
3020           AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv;
3021         }
3022         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(
3023                 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID,
3024                 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(),
3025                 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess))
3026           return true;
3027 
3028         // The conversion was successful.
3029         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
3030       }
3031 
3032       if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
3033           FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
3034         assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
3035                "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!");
3036         Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj)
3037             << From->getSourceRange();
3038       }
3039     }
3040   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
3041                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3042     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
3043           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3044       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
3045       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
3046       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
3047       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
3048         return false;
3049     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3050       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3051     } else {
3052       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3053     }
3054   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3055     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
3056       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
3057   }
3058 
3059   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
3060   // reasons.
3061   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
3062     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
3063 
3064   return false;
3065 }
3066 
3067 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
3068 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
3069 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
3070 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
3071 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
3072 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
3073                                      QualType ToType,
3074                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
3075                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
3076   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3077   if (!ToTypePtr)
3078     return false;
3079 
3080   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
3081   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3082                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
3083                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
3084     ConvertedType = ToType;
3085     return true;
3086   }
3087 
3088   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
3089   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3090   if (!FromTypePtr)
3091     return false;
3092 
3093   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
3094   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
3095   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3096   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3097 
3098   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
3099       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) {
3100     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
3101                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
3102     return true;
3103   }
3104 
3105   return false;
3106 }
3107 
3108 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
3109 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
3110 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
3111 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
3112 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
3113 /// otherwise.
3114 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3115                                         CastKind &Kind,
3116                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
3117                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
3118   QualType FromType = From->getType();
3119   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3120   if (!FromPtrType) {
3121     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
3122     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3123                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
3124            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
3125     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
3126     return false;
3127   }
3128 
3129   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3130   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
3131                       "that is not a member pointer.");
3132 
3133   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3134   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3135 
3136   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
3137   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3138   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3139 
3140   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
3141                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
3142   bool DerivationOkay =
3143       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
3144   assert(DerivationOkay &&
3145          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
3146   (void)DerivationOkay;
3147 
3148   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
3149                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
3150     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
3151     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
3152       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
3153     return true;
3154   }
3155 
3156   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
3157     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
3158       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
3159       << From->getSourceRange();
3160     return true;
3161   }
3162 
3163   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
3164     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
3165                          Paths.front(),
3166                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
3167 
3168   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
3169   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
3170   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
3171   return false;
3172 }
3173 
3174 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
3175 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
3176 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
3177                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
3178   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
3179   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
3180       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
3181     return false;
3182 
3183   return true;
3184 }
3185 
3186 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification
3187 /// conversion is valid.
3188 ///
3189 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p
3190 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every
3191 /// outer layer is const-qualified.
3192 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3193                                           bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel,
3194                                           bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
3195                                           bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3196   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
3197   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
3198 
3199   // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void.
3200   if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType())
3201     FromQuals.removeUnaligned();
3202 
3203   // Objective-C ARC:
3204   //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
3205   if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) {
3206     if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
3207       if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
3208         ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3209       FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3210       ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3211     } else {
3212       // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
3213       // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
3214       return false;
3215     }
3216   }
3217 
3218   // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
3219   if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
3220       (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
3221     FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3222     ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3223   }
3224 
3225   //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
3226   //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
3227   if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
3228     return false;
3229 
3230   // If address spaces mismatch:
3231   //  - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a
3232   //    superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow
3233   //    conversions between overlapping address spaces.
3234   //  - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion.
3235   if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() &&
3236       (!IsTopLevel ||
3237        !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) ||
3238          (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals)))))
3239     return false;
3240 
3241   //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
3242   //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
3243   if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() &&
3244       !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
3245     return false;
3246 
3247   // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
3248   // include const.
3249   PreviousToQualsIncludeConst =
3250       PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
3251   return true;
3252 }
3253 
3254 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
3255 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
3256 /// (C++ 4.4).
3257 ///
3258 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
3259 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
3260 /// object lifetime.
3261 bool
3262 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3263                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3264   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
3265   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
3266   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3267 
3268   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
3269   // qualification conversion.
3270   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
3271     return false;
3272 
3273   // (C++ 4.4p4):
3274   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
3275   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
3276   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
3277   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
3278   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
3279     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(
3280             FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer,
3281             PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion))
3282       return false;
3283     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
3284   }
3285 
3286   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
3287   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
3288   // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
3289   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
3290   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
3291   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
3292 }
3293 
3294 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
3295 /// atomic type.
3296 ///
3297 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
3298 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
3299 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3300                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
3301                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
3302                                 bool CStyle) {
3303   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
3304   if (!ToAtomic)
3305     return false;
3306 
3307   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
3308   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
3309                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
3310                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
3311     return false;
3312 
3313   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
3314   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
3315   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
3316   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3317     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
3318   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
3319   return true;
3320 }
3321 
3322 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
3323                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
3324                                               QualType Type) {
3325   const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3326   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
3327     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
3328     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
3329       return true;
3330   }
3331   return false;
3332 }
3333 
3334 static OverloadingResult
3335 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3336                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
3337                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3338                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3339                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
3340   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3341   for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) {
3342     auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3343     if (!Info)
3344       continue;
3345 
3346     bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
3347                   S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor);
3348     if (Usable) {
3349       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3350       // suppress conversions.
3351       bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3352           S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3353       if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3354         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3355                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From,
3356                                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3357                                        /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3358                                        AllowExplicit);
3359       else
3360         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From,
3361                                CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3362                                /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit);
3363     }
3364   }
3365 
3366   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3367 
3368   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3369   switch (auto Result =
3370               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3371   case OR_Deleted:
3372   case OR_Success: {
3373     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3374     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
3375     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3376     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3377     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3378     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3379     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3380     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3381     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3382     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3383     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3384     return Result;
3385   }
3386 
3387   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3388     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3389   case OR_Ambiguous:
3390     return OR_Ambiguous;
3391   }
3392 
3393   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3394 }
3395 
3396 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3397 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3398 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3399 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3400 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3401 /// false and User is unspecified.
3402 ///
3403 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3404 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3405 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3406 ///
3407 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3408 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3409 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3410 static OverloadingResult
3411 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3412                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3413                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3414                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
3415                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3416   assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None ||
3417          !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3418   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3419 
3420   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3421   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3422 
3423   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3424   // constructors.
3425   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3426     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3427     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3428     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3429     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3430     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3431     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3432     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3433     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3434     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3435         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3436          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType)))
3437       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3438 
3439     if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) {
3440       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3441     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3442                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3443 
3444       Expr **Args = &From;
3445       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3446       bool ListInitializing = false;
3447       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3448         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3449         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3450             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet,
3451             AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3452         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3453           return Result;
3454         // Never mind.
3455         CandidateSet.clear(
3456             OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3457 
3458         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3459         // arguments, not the entire list.
3460         Args = InitList->getInits();
3461         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3462         ListInitializing = true;
3463       }
3464 
3465       for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) {
3466         auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3467         if (!Info)
3468           continue;
3469 
3470         bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3471         if (!ListInitializing)
3472           Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(
3473                                  /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
3474         if (Usable) {
3475           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3476           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3477             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3478             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3479               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3480               // suppress conversions.
3481               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3482                   S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3483             }
3484           }
3485           if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3486             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
3487                 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3488                 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3489                 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3490                 /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3491                 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3492           else
3493             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3494             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3495             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl,
3496                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3497                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3498                                    /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3499                                    AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3500         }
3501       }
3502     }
3503   }
3504 
3505   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3506   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3507   } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) {
3508     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3509   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType =
3510                  From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3511     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3512          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3513       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3514       const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3515       for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
3516         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3517         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3518         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3519         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3520           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3521 
3522         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3523         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3524         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3525           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3526         else
3527           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3528 
3529         if (ConvTemplate)
3530           S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
3531               ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3532               CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3533               AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3534         else
3535           S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3536                                    CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3537                                    AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3538       }
3539     }
3540   }
3541 
3542   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3543 
3544   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3545   switch (auto Result =
3546               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3547   case OR_Success:
3548   case OR_Deleted:
3549     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3550     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3551           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3552       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3553       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3554       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3555       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3556       //   the argument of the constructor.
3557       //
3558       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3559       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3560         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3561         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3562       } else {
3563         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3564           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3565         else {
3566           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3567           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3568         }
3569       }
3570       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3571       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3572       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3573       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3574       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3575       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3576       return Result;
3577     }
3578     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3579                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3580       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3581       //
3582       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3583       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3584       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3585       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3586       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3587       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3588       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3589       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3590       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3591 
3592       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3593       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3594       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3595       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3596       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3597       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3598       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3599       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3600       //   13.3.3.1).
3601       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3602       return Result;
3603     }
3604     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3605 
3606   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3607     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3608 
3609   case OR_Ambiguous:
3610     return OR_Ambiguous;
3611   }
3612 
3613   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3614 }
3615 
3616 bool
3617 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3618   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3619   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3620                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3621   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3622     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3623                             CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false);
3624 
3625   if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ||
3626         (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())))
3627     return false;
3628 
3629   auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(
3630       *this,
3631       OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates,
3632       From);
3633   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3634     Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3635         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3636   else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()
3637     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
3638                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3639                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3640       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3641           << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3642   }
3643 
3644   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
3645                               *this, From, Cands);
3646   return true;
3647 }
3648 
3649 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the
3650 // conversion-operator return  value 'points' to, or nullptr.
3651 static const FunctionType *
3652 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) {
3653   const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3654   const PointerType *RetPtrTy =
3655       ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>();
3656 
3657   if (!RetPtrTy)
3658     return nullptr;
3659 
3660   return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3661 }
3662 
3663 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3664 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3665 /// is possible.
3666 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3667 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3668                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3669   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3670   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3671   if (!Conv1 || !Conv2)
3672     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3673 
3674   if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda())
3675     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3676 
3677   // Objective-C++:
3678   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3679   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3680   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3681   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3682   //   to keep code working.
3683   if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
3684     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3685     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3686     if (Block1 != Block2)
3687       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3688                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3689   }
3690 
3691   // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion
3692   // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is
3693   // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention
3694   // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of
3695   // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention.
3696   const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1);
3697   const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2);
3698 
3699   if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet &&
3700       Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) {
3701     CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv();
3702     CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv();
3703 
3704     CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator();
3705     const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto =
3706         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3707 
3708     CallingConv CallOpCC =
3709         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
3710     CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3711         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false);
3712     CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3713         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true);
3714 
3715     CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC};
3716     for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) {
3717       if (Conv1CC == CC)
3718         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3719       if (Conv2CC == CC)
3720         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3721     }
3722   }
3723 
3724   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3725 }
3726 
3727 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3728     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3729   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3730          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3731           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3732 }
3733 
3734 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3735 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3736 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3737 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3738 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3739                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3740                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3741 {
3742   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3743   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3744   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3745   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3746   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3747   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3748   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3749   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3750   //
3751   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3752   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3753   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3754   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3755   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3756 
3757   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3758   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3759   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3760   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3761   // standard. For example:
3762   //
3763   // int &f(...);    // #1
3764   // void f(char*);  // #2
3765   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3766   //
3767   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3768   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3769   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3770   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3771   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3772   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3773   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3774 
3775   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3776       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3777       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3778     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3779                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3780                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3781 
3782   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3783     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3784   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3785     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3786 
3787   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3788   // the same kind.
3789   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3790     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3791 
3792   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3793       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3794 
3795   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3796   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3797   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3798 
3799   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3800   // list-initialization sequence L2 if:
3801   // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or,
3802   //   if not that,
3803   // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T",
3804   //   and N1 is smaller than N2.,
3805   // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply.
3806   if (!ICS1.isBad()) {
3807     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3808         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3809       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3810     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3811         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3812       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3813   }
3814 
3815   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3816     // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than
3817     // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...]
3818     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3819                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3820   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3821     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3822     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3823     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3824     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3825     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3826     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3827     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3828           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3829       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3830                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3831                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3832     else
3833       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3834                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3835                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3836   }
3837 
3838   return Result;
3839 }
3840 
3841 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3842 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3843 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3844 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3845                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3846                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3847   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3848     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3849 
3850   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3851   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3852   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3853     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3854   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3855     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3856 
3857   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3858     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3859       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3860     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3861       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3862     else
3863       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3864   } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3865     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3866 
3867   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3868     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3869                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3870   }
3871 
3872   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3873     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3874              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3875              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3876 
3877   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3878     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3879              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3880              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3881 
3882   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3883 }
3884 
3885 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3886 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3887 static bool
3888 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3889                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3890   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3891   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3892   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3893   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3894   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3895   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3896   //      reference*.
3897   //
3898   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3899   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3900   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3901   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3902   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3903   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3904       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3905     return false;
3906 
3907   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3908           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3909          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3910           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3911 }
3912 
3913 enum class FixedEnumPromotion {
3914   None,
3915   ToUnderlyingType,
3916   ToPromotedUnderlyingType
3917 };
3918 
3919 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses.
3920 static FixedEnumPromotion
3921 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
3922 
3923   if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion)
3924     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3925 
3926   QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType();
3927   if (!FromType->isEnumeralType())
3928     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3929 
3930   EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl();
3931   if (!Enum->isFixed())
3932     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3933 
3934   QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType();
3935   if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType))
3936     return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType;
3937 
3938   return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType;
3939 }
3940 
3941 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3942 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3943 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3944 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3945 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3946                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3947                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3948 {
3949   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3950   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3951 
3952   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3953   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3954   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3955   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3956   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3957   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3958         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3959     return CK;
3960 
3961   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3962   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3963   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3964   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3965   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3966     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3967   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3968     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3969 
3970   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3971   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3972   // applies:
3973 
3974   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3975   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3976   //   that is such a conversion.
3977   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3978     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3979              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3980              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3981 
3982   // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3983   // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601.
3984   //
3985   //   A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed
3986   //   to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted
3987   //   underlying type, if the two are different.
3988   FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1);
3989   FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2);
3990   if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None &&
3991       FEP1 != FEP2)
3992     return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType
3993                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3994                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3995 
3996   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3997   //
3998   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3999   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
4000   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
4001   //   of B* to void*.
4002   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
4003     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4004   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
4005     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4006   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4007     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
4008     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
4009     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4010                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4011   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4012     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
4013     // their derived-to-base conversions.
4014     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
4015           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2))
4016       return DerivedCK;
4017   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
4018              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
4019     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
4020     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
4021     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
4022     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4023     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4024 
4025     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4026     // conversion, if we need to.
4027     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4028       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4029     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4030       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4031 
4032     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4033     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4034 
4035     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4036       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4037     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4038       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4039 
4040     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
4041     // other, it is the better one.
4042     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
4043       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4044     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
4045       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4046     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
4047       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
4048                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
4049       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
4050                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
4051       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
4052         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4053                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4054       }
4055     }
4056   }
4057 
4058   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4059     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
4060     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
4061       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4062     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
4063       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4064   }
4065 
4066   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
4067   // bullet 3).
4068   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
4069         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
4070     return QualCK;
4071 
4072   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4073     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
4074     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
4075     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
4076     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
4077     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
4078     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
4079     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4080     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4081     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4082     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4083     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4084     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4085     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4086     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4087       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
4088       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
4089       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
4090                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
4091         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
4092                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4093                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4094       }
4095 
4096       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
4097       // type for comparison.
4098       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4099         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4100       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4101         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4102       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
4103         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4104       if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
4105         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4106     }
4107   }
4108 
4109   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
4110   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
4111   // is between types of the same size.
4112   // For example:
4113   // void f(float);
4114   // void f(int);
4115   // int main {
4116   //    long a;
4117   //    f(a);
4118   // }
4119   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
4120   // as clang will do in standard mode.
4121   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
4122       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
4123       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
4124           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
4125     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4126 
4127   // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion
4128   // For example:
4129   //
4130   // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16)));
4131   // void f(vector float);
4132   // void f(vector signed int);
4133   // int main() {
4134   //   __v4sf a;
4135   //   f(a);
4136   // }
4137   // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not
4138   // report an ambiguous call error
4139   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion &&
4140       SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) {
4141     bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4142         SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4143     bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4144         SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4145 
4146     if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion)
4147       return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion
4148                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4149                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4150   }
4151 
4152   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion &&
4153       SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) {
4154     bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4155         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4156     bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4157         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4158 
4159     if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion !=
4160         SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion)
4161       return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion
4162                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4163                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4164   }
4165 
4166   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4167 }
4168 
4169 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4170 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4171 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
4172 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4173 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
4174                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4175                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4176   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
4177   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
4178   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
4179   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
4180   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
4181   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
4182   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
4183       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
4184     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4185 
4186   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
4187   // conversion (!)
4188   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4189   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4190   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4191   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4192   assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType());
4193   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4194   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4195   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4196 
4197   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping
4198   // them.
4199   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
4200     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4201 
4202   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
4203     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4204 
4205   // Objective-C++ ARC:
4206   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
4207   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
4208   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
4209                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
4210     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
4211                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4212                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4213   }
4214 
4215   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) {
4216     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
4217     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
4218     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
4219     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
4220     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
4221     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
4222     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
4223     // strict subset of qualifiers.
4224     if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() ==
4225         T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime())
4226       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
4227       // about how the sequences rank.
4228       // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with
4229       // the ARC overload rule.
4230       ;
4231     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
4232       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4233       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4234         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4235         // qualifiers.
4236         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4237 
4238       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4239     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
4240       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4241       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
4242         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4243         // qualifiers.
4244         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4245 
4246       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4247     } else {
4248       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
4249       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4250     }
4251 
4252     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
4253     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4254       break;
4255   }
4256 
4257   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
4258   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
4259   switch (Result) {
4260   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
4261     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4262       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4263     break;
4264 
4265   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
4266     break;
4267 
4268   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
4269     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4270       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4271     break;
4272   }
4273 
4274   return Result;
4275 }
4276 
4277 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4278 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4279 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
4280 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
4281 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
4282 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4283 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
4284                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4285                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4286   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4287   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
4288   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4289   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
4290 
4291   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4292   // conversion, if we need to.
4293   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4294     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4295   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4296     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4297 
4298   // Canonicalize all of the types.
4299   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
4300   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
4301   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
4302   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
4303 
4304   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
4305   //
4306   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
4307   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
4308   //
4309   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
4310   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4311       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4312       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
4313       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
4314       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
4315     QualType FromPointee1 =
4316         FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4317     QualType ToPointee1 =
4318         ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4319     QualType FromPointee2 =
4320         FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4321     QualType ToPointee2 =
4322         ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4323 
4324     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4325     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4326       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4327         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4328       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4329         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4330     }
4331 
4332     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4333     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
4334       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4335         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4336       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4337         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4338     }
4339   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4340              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4341     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
4342       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4343     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
4344       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4345     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
4346       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4347     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
4348       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4349 
4350     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
4351       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
4352       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
4353       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
4354       // Objective-C pointer types.
4355       bool FromAssignLeft
4356         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
4357       bool FromAssignRight
4358         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
4359       bool ToAssignLeft
4360         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
4361       bool ToAssignRight
4362         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
4363 
4364       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
4365       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
4366       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
4367           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4368         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4369       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
4370           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4371         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4372 
4373       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
4374       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
4375       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4376         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4377       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4378         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4379 
4380       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
4381       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
4382       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4383           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4384         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4385       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
4386           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4387         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4388 
4389       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
4390       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
4391       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4392         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4393       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4394         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4395 
4396       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4397       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4398           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4399           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) {
4400         if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) {
4401           // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to
4402           // C *.
4403           bool IsFirstSame =
4404               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl();
4405           bool IsSecondSame =
4406               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl();
4407           if (IsFirstSame) {
4408             if (!IsSecondSame)
4409               return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4410           } else if (IsSecondSame)
4411             return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4412         }
4413         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4414                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4415       }
4416 
4417       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4418       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
4419           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
4420         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4421         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4422     }
4423   }
4424 
4425   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
4426   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
4427       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
4428       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
4429     const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4430     const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4431     const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4432     const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4433     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
4434     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
4435     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
4436     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
4437     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4438     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4439     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4440     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4441     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
4442     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4443       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4444         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4445       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4446         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4447     }
4448     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
4449     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
4450       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4451         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4452       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4453         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4454     }
4455   }
4456 
4457   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4458     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
4459     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
4460     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4461     //      reference of type A&,
4462     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4463         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4464       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2))
4465         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4466       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1))
4467         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4468     }
4469 
4470     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
4471     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
4472     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4473     //      reference of type A&,
4474     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4475         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4476       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1))
4477         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4478       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2))
4479         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4480     }
4481   }
4482 
4483   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4484 }
4485 
4486 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
4487 /// C++ class.
4488 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
4489   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
4490     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
4491 
4492   return true;
4493 }
4494 
4495 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) {
4496   if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
4497     return T;
4498 
4499   Qualifiers Q;
4500   T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q);
4501   Q.removeUnaligned();
4502   return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q);
4503 }
4504 
4505 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
4506 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible,
4507 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
4508 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
4509 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
4510 /// type being initialized.
4511 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
4512 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
4513                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
4514                                    ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) {
4515   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
4516     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
4517   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
4518 
4519   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
4520   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
4521   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4522   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4523   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4524 
4525   ReferenceConversions ConvTmp;
4526   ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp;
4527   Conv = ReferenceConversions();
4528 
4529   // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4530   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4531   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or
4532   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4533   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if
4534   //   a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type
4535   //   "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence.
4536 
4537   // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base
4538   // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions.
4539   // (Qualification conversions are checked last.)
4540   QualType ConvertedT2;
4541   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4542     // Nothing to do.
4543   } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) &&
4544              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4545              IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4546     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase;
4547   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4548            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4549            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4550     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC;
4551   else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() &&
4552            IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) {
4553     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function;
4554     // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them.
4555     return Ref_Compatible;
4556   }
4557   bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0;
4558 
4559   // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are
4560   // similar at the same time.
4561   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
4562   bool TopLevel = true;
4563   do {
4564     if (T1 == T2)
4565       break;
4566 
4567     // We will need a qualification conversion.
4568     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification;
4569 
4570     // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other
4571     // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in
4572     // overload resolution.
4573     if (!TopLevel)
4574       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification;
4575 
4576     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4577     T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1);
4578     T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2);
4579 
4580     // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible,
4581     // but are still be reference-related if they're similar.
4582     bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4583     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel,
4584                                        PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
4585                                        ObjCLifetimeConversion))
4586       return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2))
4587                  ? Ref_Related
4588                  : Ref_Incompatible;
4589 
4590     // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first?
4591     if (ObjCLifetimeConversion)
4592       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime;
4593 
4594     TopLevel = false;
4595   } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2));
4596 
4597   // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the
4598   // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how
4599   // to convert the referent.
4600   return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4601              ? Ref_Compatible
4602              : Ref_Incompatible;
4603 }
4604 
4605 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible
4606 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4607 static bool
4608 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4609                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4610                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4611                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4612   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4613   auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4614 
4615   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
4616       DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
4617   const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4618   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
4619     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4620     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4621     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4622       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4623 
4624     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4625       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4626     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4627     if (ConvTemplate)
4628       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4629     else
4630       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4631 
4632     if (AllowRvalues) {
4633       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4634       // functions that return lvalues.
4635       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4636         const ReferenceType *RefType
4637           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4638         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4639           continue;
4640       }
4641 
4642       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4643           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4644               DeclLoc,
4645               Conv->getConversionType()
4646                   .getNonReferenceType()
4647                   .getUnqualifiedType(),
4648               DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) ==
4649               Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4650         continue;
4651     } else {
4652       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4653       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4654       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4655 
4656       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4657         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4658       if (!RefType ||
4659           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4660            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4661         continue;
4662     }
4663 
4664     if (ConvTemplate)
4665       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
4666           ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4667           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4668     else
4669       S.AddConversionCandidate(
4670           Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4671           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4672   }
4673 
4674   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4675 
4676   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4677   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) {
4678   case OR_Success:
4679     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4680     //
4681     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4682     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4683     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4684     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4685     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4686     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4687     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4688     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4689     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4690       return false;
4691 
4692     ICS.setUserDefined();
4693     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4694     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4695     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4696     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4697     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4698     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4699     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4700            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4701            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4702     return true;
4703 
4704   case OR_Ambiguous:
4705     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4706     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4707          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4708       if (Cand->Best)
4709         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
4710     return true;
4711 
4712   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4713   case OR_Deleted:
4714     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4715     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4716     return false;
4717   }
4718 
4719   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4720 }
4721 
4722 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4723 /// initialization.
4724 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4725 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4726                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4727                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4728                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4729   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4730 
4731   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4732   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4733   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4734 
4735   QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4736   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4737 
4738   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4739   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4740   // type of the resulting function.
4741   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4742     DeclAccessPair Found;
4743     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4744                                                                 false, Found))
4745       T2 = Fn->getType();
4746   }
4747 
4748   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4749   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4750   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4751 
4752   Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv;
4753   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
4754       S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv);
4755 
4756   auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) {
4757     ICS.setStandard();
4758     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4759     // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should
4760     // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings.
4761     ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase)
4762                               ? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4763                               : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC)
4764                                     ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4765                                     : ICK_Identity;
4766     // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank
4767     // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification
4768     // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion.
4769     ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv &
4770                               Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification)
4771                              ? ICK_Qualification
4772                              : ICK_Identity;
4773     ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2);
4774     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4775     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4776     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4777     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4778     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly;
4779     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4780     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4781     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4782     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4783     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding =
4784         (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0;
4785     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4786     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4787   };
4788 
4789   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4790   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4791   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4792 
4793   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4794   if (!isRValRef) {
4795     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4796     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4797     //
4798     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4799     if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) {
4800       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4801       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4802       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4803       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4804       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4805       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4806       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4807       SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true);
4808 
4809       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4810       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4811       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4812       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4813       return ICS;
4814     }
4815 
4816     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4817     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4818     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4819     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4820     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4821     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4822     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4823     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4824         S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4825         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4826       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4827                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4828                                    AllowExplicit))
4829         return ICS;
4830     }
4831   }
4832 
4833   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4834   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4835   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4836   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4837     if (InitCategory.isRValue() && RefRelationship != Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4838       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4839     return ICS;
4840   }
4841 
4842   //       -- If the initializer expression
4843   //
4844   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4845   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4846   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible &&
4847       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4848        (InitCategory.isPRValue() &&
4849           (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4850        (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4851     // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4852     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4853     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4854     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4855     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4856     SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4857                           !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()));
4858     return ICS;
4859   }
4860 
4861   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4862   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4863   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4864   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4865   //               "cv3 T3",
4866   //
4867   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4868   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4869   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4870   //          class subobject).
4871   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4872       T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4873       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4874                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4875                                AllowExplicit)) {
4876     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4877     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4878     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4879     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4880     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4881         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4882       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4883 
4884     return ICS;
4885   }
4886 
4887   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4888   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4889     return ICS;
4890 
4891   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4892   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4893   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4894   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4895   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4896   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4897   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4898   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4899     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4900     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4901     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4902     // initialization fails.
4903     //
4904     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4905     // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important.
4906     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4907     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4908     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4909     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4910     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4911     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4912     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4913     T1Quals.removeUnaligned();
4914     T2Quals.removeUnaligned();
4915     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4916       return ICS;
4917   }
4918 
4919   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4920   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4921   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4922   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4923   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4924   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4925       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4926     return ICS;
4927 
4928   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4929   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4930   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && isRValRef &&
4931       Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) {
4932     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, Init, DeclType);
4933     return ICS;
4934   }
4935 
4936   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4937   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4938   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4939   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4940   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4941   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4942   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4943   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4944   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4945   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4946   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4947                               AllowedExplicit::None,
4948                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4949                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4950                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4951                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4952 
4953   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4954   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4955     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4956     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4957     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4958     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4959     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4960     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4961   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4962     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4963         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4964             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4965 
4966     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4967     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4968     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4969     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4970     //   lvalue.
4971     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4972     if (isRValRef && LValRefType) {
4973       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4974       return ICS;
4975     }
4976 
4977     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4978     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4979     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4980     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4981     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4982     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4983   }
4984 
4985   return ICS;
4986 }
4987 
4988 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4989 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4990                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4991                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4992                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4993                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4994 
4995 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4996 /// initializer list From.
4997 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4998 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4999                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
5000                   bool InOverloadResolution,
5001                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
5002   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
5003   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
5004   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
5005 
5006   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
5007   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
5008 
5009   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
5010   // initialized from init lists.
5011   if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType))
5012     return Result;
5013 
5014   // Per DR1467:
5015   //   If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single
5016   //   element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the
5017   //   implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element
5018   //   to the parameter type.
5019   //
5020   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ]
5021   //   and the initializer list has a single element that is an
5022   //   appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the
5023   //   implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion.
5024   if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5025     if (ToType->isRecordType()) {
5026       QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType();
5027       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) ||
5028           S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType))
5029         return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5030                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5031                                      InOverloadResolution,
5032                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5033     }
5034 
5035     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) {
5036       if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) {
5037         InitializedEntity Entity =
5038           InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5039                                                  /*Consumed=*/false);
5040         if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
5041           Result.setStandard();
5042           Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5043           Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5044           Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5045           return Result;
5046         }
5047       }
5048     }
5049   }
5050 
5051   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below).
5052   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
5053   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
5054   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
5055   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
5056   //   element of the list to X.
5057   //
5058   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3:
5059   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer
5060   //   list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is
5061   //   default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list
5062   //   can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is
5063   //   the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X.
5064   //
5065   // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks.
5066   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
5067   QualType X;
5068   if (ToType->isArrayType())
5069     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
5070   else
5071     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
5072   if (!X.isNull()) {
5073     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
5074       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
5075       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5076           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
5077                                 InOverloadResolution,
5078                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5079       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
5080       if (ICS.isBad()) {
5081         Result = ICS;
5082         break;
5083       }
5084       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
5085       if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
5086                                 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) ==
5087                                 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
5088         Result = ICS;
5089     }
5090 
5091     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
5092     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
5093     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
5094       Result.setStandard();
5095       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5096       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5097       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5098     }
5099 
5100     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
5101     return Result;
5102   }
5103 
5104   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4:
5105   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
5106   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
5107   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
5108   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
5109   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
5110   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5111   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5112     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
5113     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5114                                     AllowedExplicit::None,
5115                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
5116                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5117                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5118   }
5119 
5120   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5:
5121   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
5122   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
5123   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
5124   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5125   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5126     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
5127     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
5128     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
5129     InitializedEntity Entity =
5130         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5131                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
5132     if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity,
5133                                                                  From)) {
5134       Result.setUserDefined();
5135       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
5136       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
5137       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
5138       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
5139 
5140       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5141       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
5142       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5143       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
5144     }
5145     return Result;
5146   }
5147 
5148   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6:
5149   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
5150   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
5151   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
5152     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
5153     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
5154     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
5155 
5156     QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5157 
5158     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
5159     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
5160     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5161       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
5162 
5163       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
5164 
5165       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
5166       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
5167       // type of the resulting function.
5168       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
5169         DeclAccessPair Found;
5170         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
5171                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
5172           T2 = Fn->getType();
5173       }
5174 
5175       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
5176       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
5177           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2);
5178 
5179       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
5180         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5181                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5182                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5183       }
5184     }
5185 
5186     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
5187     // initializer list.
5188     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
5189                                InOverloadResolution,
5190                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5191     if (Result.isFailure())
5192       return Result;
5193     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
5194            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
5195 
5196     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
5197     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
5198         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
5199       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
5200                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
5201       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
5202       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
5203       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
5204       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5205       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
5206       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
5207     } else
5208       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
5209                     From, ToType);
5210     return Result;
5211   }
5212 
5213   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7:
5214   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
5215   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
5216   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
5217     //    - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an
5218     //      initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one
5219     //      required to convert the element to the parameter type.
5220     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
5221     if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0)))
5222       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5223                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5224                                      InOverloadResolution,
5225                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5226     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
5227     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
5228     else if (NumInits == 0) {
5229       Result.setStandard();
5230       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5231       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5232       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5233     }
5234     return Result;
5235   }
5236 
5237   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8:
5238   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
5239   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
5240   return Result;
5241 }
5242 
5243 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
5244 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
5245 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
5246 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
5247 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
5248 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
5249 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5250 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5251                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
5252                       bool InOverloadResolution,
5253                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5254                       bool AllowExplicit) {
5255   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
5256     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5257                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5258 
5259   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
5260     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
5261                             /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5262                             SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit);
5263 
5264   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
5265                                SuppressUserConversions,
5266                                AllowedExplicit::None,
5267                                InOverloadResolution,
5268                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5269                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5270                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5271 }
5272 
5273 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
5274                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
5275                                   Sema &S,
5276                                   SourceLocation Loc,
5277                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
5278   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
5279   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5280     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
5281 
5282   return !ICS.isBad();
5283 }
5284 
5285 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
5286 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
5287 /// expression @p From.
5288 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5289 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType,
5290                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
5291                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
5292                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
5293   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
5294   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
5295   //                 const volatile object.
5296   Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers();
5297   if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) {
5298     Quals.addConst();
5299     Quals.addVolatile();
5300   }
5301 
5302   QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
5303 
5304   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
5305   // to exit early.
5306   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
5307 
5308   // We need to have an object of class type.
5309   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5310     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
5311 
5312     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
5313     // better have an lvalue.
5314     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
5315   }
5316 
5317   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
5318 
5319   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
5320   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
5321   //   parameter is
5322   //
5323   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
5324   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
5325   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
5326   //        ref-qualifier
5327   //
5328   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
5329   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
5330   //
5331   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
5332   // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions
5333   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
5334   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
5335   // non-constant references.
5336 
5337   // First check the qualifiers.
5338   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
5339   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
5340                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
5341       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
5342     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5343                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5344     return ICS;
5345   }
5346 
5347   if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) {
5348     Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers();
5349     Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers();
5350     if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) {
5351       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5352                  FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5353       return ICS;
5354     }
5355   }
5356 
5357   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
5358   // affects the conversion rank.
5359   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
5360   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
5361   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
5362     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
5363   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType))
5364     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
5365   else {
5366     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
5367                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5368     return ICS;
5369   }
5370 
5371   // Check the ref-qualifier.
5372   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
5373   case RQ_None:
5374     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
5375     break;
5376 
5377   case RQ_LValue:
5378     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) {
5379       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
5380       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
5381                  ImplicitParamType);
5382       return ICS;
5383     }
5384     break;
5385 
5386   case RQ_RValue:
5387     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
5388       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
5389       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
5390                  ImplicitParamType);
5391       return ICS;
5392     }
5393     break;
5394   }
5395 
5396   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
5397   ICS.setStandard();
5398   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5399   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
5400   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
5401   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
5402   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
5403   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
5404   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
5405   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5406   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
5407   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
5408     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
5409   return ICS;
5410 }
5411 
5412 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
5413 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
5414 /// expression.
5415 ExprResult
5416 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
5417                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
5418                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5419                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
5420   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
5421   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
5422     Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5423 
5424   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
5425   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5426     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
5427     DestType = Method->getThisType();
5428     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
5429   } else {
5430     FromRecordType = From->getType();
5431     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
5432     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
5433 
5434     // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary.
5435     if (From->isRValue()) {
5436       From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From,
5437                                             Method->getRefQualifier() !=
5438                                                 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue);
5439     }
5440   }
5441 
5442   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
5443   // the actual argument initialization.
5444   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
5445       *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method,
5446       Method->getParent());
5447   if (ICS.isBad()) {
5448     switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) {
5449     case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: {
5450       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
5451       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
5452       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
5453       if (CVR) {
5454         Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
5455             << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
5456             << From->getSourceRange();
5457         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5458           << Method->getDeclName();
5459         return ExprError();
5460       }
5461       break;
5462     }
5463 
5464     case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue:
5465     case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: {
5466       bool IsRValueQualified =
5467         Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue;
5468       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref)
5469           << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue()
5470           << IsRValueQualified;
5471       Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5472         << Method->getDeclName();
5473       return ExprError();
5474     }
5475 
5476     case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion:
5477     case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class:
5478       break;
5479     }
5480 
5481     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type)
5482            << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType
5483            << From->getSourceRange();
5484   }
5485 
5486   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
5487     ExprResult FromRes =
5488       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
5489     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
5490       return ExprError();
5491     From = FromRes.get();
5492   }
5493 
5494   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) {
5495     CastKind CK;
5496     QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType();
5497     LangAS DestAS =
5498         PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace();
5499     if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS)
5500       CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5501     else
5502       CK = CK_NoOp;
5503     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get();
5504   }
5505   return From;
5506 }
5507 
5508 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
5509 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5510 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5511 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5512   // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8:
5513   //   - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source
5514   //     type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial
5515   //     value of the object being initialized is false.
5516   if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType())
5517     return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(),
5518                                                         S.Context.BoolTy,
5519                                                         From->isGLValue());
5520 
5521   // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit
5522   // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted.
5523   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
5524                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5525                                AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5526                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5527                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5528                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5529                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5530 }
5531 
5532 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
5533 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5534 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
5535   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5536     return ExprError();
5537 
5538   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
5539   if (!ICS.isBad())
5540     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
5541 
5542   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
5543     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
5544            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
5545   return ExprError();
5546 }
5547 
5548 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
5549 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
5550 /// is acceptable.
5551 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
5552                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5553   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
5554   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
5555   // conversions are fine.
5556   switch (SCS.Second) {
5557   case ICK_Identity:
5558   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
5559   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere.
5560   case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion:
5561     return true;
5562 
5563   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
5564     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
5565     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral
5566     // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression.
5567     //
5568     // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks
5569     // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this
5570     // (non-conforming) extension.
5571     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5572            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
5573 
5574   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
5575   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
5576     // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are
5577     // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t.
5578     return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType();
5579 
5580   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
5581   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
5582   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
5583   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
5584   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
5585   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
5586   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
5587   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
5588   case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion:
5589   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
5590   case ICK_Complex_Real:
5591   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
5592   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
5593   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
5594   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
5595   case ICK_C_Only_Conversion:
5596   case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion:
5597     return false;
5598 
5599   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
5600   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
5601   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
5602     llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second");
5603 
5604   case ICK_Function_Conversion:
5605   case ICK_Qualification:
5606     llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second");
5607 
5608   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
5609     break;
5610   }
5611 
5612   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
5613 }
5614 
5615 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
5616 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
5617 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
5618 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From,
5619                                                    QualType T, APValue &Value,
5620                                                    Sema::CCEKind CCE,
5621                                                    bool RequireInt,
5622                                                    NamedDecl *Dest,
5623                                                    bool *ValueDependent) {
5624   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
5625          "converted constant expression outside C++11");
5626 
5627   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From))
5628     return ExprError();
5629 
5630   // C++1z [expr.const]p3:
5631   //  A converted constant expression of type T is an expression,
5632   //  implicitly converted to type T, where the converted
5633   //  expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion
5634   //  sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...].
5635   // C++1z [stmt.if]p2:
5636   //  If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the
5637   //  condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type
5638   //  bool.
5639   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5640       CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool
5641           ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From)
5642           : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T,
5643                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5644                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5645                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5646                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5647   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5648   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5649   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5650     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5651     break;
5652   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5653     if (T->isRecordType())
5654       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before;
5655     else
5656       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5657     break;
5658   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5659   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5660     if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5661       return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5662                     diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5663              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5664     return ExprError();
5665 
5666   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5667     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5668   }
5669 
5670   // Check that we would only use permitted conversions.
5671   if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) {
5672     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5673                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5674            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5675   }
5676   // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly.
5677   if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) {
5678     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5679                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect)
5680            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5681   }
5682 
5683   // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed
5684   // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of
5685   // class type.
5686   ExprResult Result;
5687   if (T->isRecordType()) {
5688     assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg &&
5689            "unexpected class type converted constant expr");
5690     Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
5691         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter(
5692             T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)),
5693         SourceLocation(), From);
5694   } else {
5695     Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting);
5696   }
5697   if (Result.isInvalid())
5698     return Result;
5699 
5700   // C++2a [intro.execution]p5:
5701   //   A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...]
5702   Result =
5703       S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(),
5704                             /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true);
5705   if (Result.isInvalid())
5706     return Result;
5707 
5708   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5709   bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false;
5710   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5711   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5712   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5713                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5714   case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
5715     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
5716     // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
5717   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5718     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5719     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5720   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5721     break;
5722 
5723   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5724     if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound &&
5725         PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5726         PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) {
5727       // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise
5728       // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through.
5729       ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true;
5730       break;
5731     }
5732     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5733         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1
5734         << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5735     break;
5736 
5737   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5738     // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a
5739     // constant expression.
5740     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5741         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T;
5742     break;
5743   }
5744 
5745   if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) {
5746     Value = APValue();
5747     if (ValueDependent)
5748       *ValueDependent = true;
5749     return Result;
5750   }
5751 
5752   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5753   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5754   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5755   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5756 
5757   ConstantExprKind Kind;
5758   if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType())
5759     Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument;
5760   else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg)
5761     Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument;
5762   else
5763     Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal;
5764 
5765   if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) ||
5766       (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) {
5767     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5768     // the AST.
5769     Result = ExprError();
5770   } else {
5771     Value = Eval.Val;
5772     if (ValueDependent)
5773       *ValueDependent = Eval.Dependent;
5774 
5775     if (Notes.empty()) {
5776       // It's a constant expression.
5777       Expr *E = Result.get();
5778       if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E))
5779         E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value);
5780       if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue)
5781         Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue);
5782       return E;
5783     }
5784   }
5785 
5786   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5787   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5788       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
5789     S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5790   } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
5791                                    diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) {
5792     Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg);
5793     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5794       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5795   } else {
5796     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5797         << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5798     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5799       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5800   }
5801   return ExprError();
5802 }
5803 
5804 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5805                                                   APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE,
5806                                                   NamedDecl *Dest,
5807                                                   bool *ValueDependent) {
5808   return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false,
5809                                             Dest, ValueDependent);
5810 }
5811 
5812 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5813                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
5814                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
5815   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
5816 
5817   APValue V;
5818   auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true,
5819                                               /*Dest=*/nullptr,
5820                                               /*ValueDependent=*/nullptr);
5821   if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent())
5822     Value = V.getInt();
5823   return R;
5824 }
5825 
5826 
5827 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5828 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5829 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5830 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5831   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5832     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5833     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5834     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5835   }
5836 }
5837 
5838 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5839 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5840 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5841 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5842   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5843   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5844   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5845     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5846                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5847                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5848                             AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5849                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5850                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5851                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5852                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5853 
5854   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5855   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5856   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5857   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5858   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5859     break;
5860 
5861   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5862     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5863     break;
5864 
5865   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5866     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5867     break;
5868   }
5869 
5870   return ICS;
5871 }
5872 
5873 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5874 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5875 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists.
5876 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5877   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5878     return ExprError();
5879 
5880   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5881   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5882     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5883   if (!ICS.isBad())
5884     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5885   return ExprResult();
5886 }
5887 
5888 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5889 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5890 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5891   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5892                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5893 }
5894 
5895 static ExprResult
5896 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5897                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5898                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5899 
5900   if (Converter.Suppress)
5901     return ExprError();
5902 
5903   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5904   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5905     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5906         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5907     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5908     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5909   }
5910   return From;
5911 }
5912 
5913 static bool
5914 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5915                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5916                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5917                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5918   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5919     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5920     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5921         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5922 
5923     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5924     // conversion; use it.
5925     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5926     std::string TypeStr;
5927     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5928 
5929     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5930         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(),
5931                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5932         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5933                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")");
5934     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5935 
5936     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5937     // explicit conversion function.
5938     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5939       return true;
5940 
5941     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5942     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5943                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5944     if (Result.isInvalid())
5945       return true;
5946     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5947     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5948                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5949                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5950                                     SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5951   }
5952   return false;
5953 }
5954 
5955 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5956                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5957                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5958                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5959   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5960       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5961   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5962 
5963   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5964   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5965     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5966       return true;
5967 
5968     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5969         << From->getSourceRange();
5970   }
5971 
5972   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5973                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5974   if (Result.isInvalid())
5975     return true;
5976   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5977   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5978                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5979                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5980                                   SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5981   return false;
5982 }
5983 
5984 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5985     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5986     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5987   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5988     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5989         << From->getSourceRange();
5990 
5991   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5992 }
5993 
5994 static void
5995 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5996                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5997                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5998   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5999     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
6000     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6001     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
6002     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6003       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6004 
6005     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
6006     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
6007     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
6008       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6009     else
6010       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6011 
6012     if (ConvTemplate)
6013       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
6014           ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
6015           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6016     else
6017       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
6018                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
6019                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false,
6020                                      /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6021   }
6022 }
6023 
6024 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
6025 /// by the given converter.
6026 ///
6027 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
6028 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
6029 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
6030 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
6031 /// one target type.
6032 ///
6033 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
6034 /// conversion.
6035 ///
6036 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
6037 ///
6038 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
6039 ///
6040 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
6041 /// successful.
6042 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
6043     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
6044   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
6045   if (From->isTypeDependent())
6046     return From;
6047 
6048   // Process placeholders immediately.
6049   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6050     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
6051     if (result.isInvalid())
6052       return result;
6053     From = result.get();
6054   }
6055 
6056   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
6057   QualType T = From->getType();
6058   if (Converter.match(T))
6059     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
6060 
6061   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
6062 
6063   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
6064   // type.
6065   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
6066   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6067     if (!Converter.Suppress)
6068       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6069     return From;
6070   }
6071 
6072   // We must have a complete class type.
6073   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
6074     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
6075     Expr *From;
6076 
6077     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
6078         : Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
6079 
6080     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
6081       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6082     }
6083   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
6084 
6085   if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T)
6086                          : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
6087     return From;
6088 
6089   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
6090   UnresolvedSet<4>
6091       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
6092   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
6093   const auto &Conversions =
6094       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6095 
6096   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
6097       (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1);
6098 
6099   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
6100   QualType ToType;
6101   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
6102 
6103   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
6104   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6105     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6106     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
6107     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6108     if (ConvTemplate) {
6109       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
6110         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6111       else
6112         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
6113     } else
6114       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6115 
6116     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
6117            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
6118            "viable in C++1y");
6119 
6120     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6121     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
6122 
6123       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
6124         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
6125         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
6126         if (!ConvTemplate)
6127           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6128       } else {
6129         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6130           if (ToType.isNull())
6131             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
6132           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
6133                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
6134             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
6135         }
6136         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6137       }
6138     }
6139   }
6140 
6141   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6142     // C++1y [conv]p6:
6143     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
6144     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
6145     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
6146     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
6147     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
6148     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
6149     // exactly one such T.
6150 
6151     // If no unique T is found:
6152     if (ToType.isNull()) {
6153       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6154                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6155                                      ExplicitConversions))
6156         return ExprError();
6157       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6158     }
6159 
6160     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
6161     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
6162       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6163                                          ViableConversions);
6164 
6165     // If one unique T is found:
6166     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
6167     // potentially viable conversions.
6168     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
6169     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
6170                                       CandidateSet);
6171 
6172     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
6173     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
6174     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
6175     case OR_Success: {
6176       // Apply this conversion.
6177       DeclAccessPair Found =
6178           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
6179       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6180                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6181         return ExprError();
6182       break;
6183     }
6184     case OR_Ambiguous:
6185       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6186                                          ViableConversions);
6187     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
6188       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6189                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6190                                      ExplicitConversions))
6191         return ExprError();
6192       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
6193     case OR_Deleted:
6194       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6195       break;
6196     }
6197   } else {
6198     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
6199     case 0: {
6200       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6201                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6202                                      ExplicitConversions))
6203         return ExprError();
6204 
6205       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6206       break;
6207     }
6208     case 1: {
6209       // Apply this conversion.
6210       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
6211       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6212                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6213         return ExprError();
6214       break;
6215     }
6216     default:
6217       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6218                                          ViableConversions);
6219     }
6220   }
6221 
6222   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6223 }
6224 
6225 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
6226 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
6227 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
6228 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
6229 /// enumeration types.
6230 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
6231                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
6232                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
6233   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
6234   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
6235 
6236   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
6237     return true;
6238 
6239   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
6240     return true;
6241 
6242   const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6243   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
6244     return false;
6245 
6246   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
6247     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
6248     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
6249       return true;
6250   }
6251 
6252   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
6253     return false;
6254 
6255   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
6256     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
6257     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
6258       return true;
6259   }
6260 
6261   return false;
6262 }
6263 
6264 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
6265 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
6266 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
6267 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
6268 ///
6269 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
6270 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
6271 /// code completion.
6272 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(
6273     FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6274     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
6275     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6276     ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6277     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6278   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6279     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6280   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6281   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6282          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
6283 
6284   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6285     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
6286       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
6287       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
6288       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
6289       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
6290       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
6291       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
6292       // is irrelevant.
6293       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(),
6294                          Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args,
6295                          CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6296                          PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO);
6297       return;
6298     }
6299     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
6300     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
6301   }
6302 
6303   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO))
6304     return;
6305 
6306   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
6307   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
6308   //   overload resolution.
6309   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
6310   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
6311       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
6312     return;
6313 
6314   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6315   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6316       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6317 
6318   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6319   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
6320   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
6321   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
6322   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
6323   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
6324   //   candidate functions.
6325   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
6326       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
6327     return;
6328 
6329   // Add this candidate
6330   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6331       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions);
6332   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6333   Candidate.Function = Function;
6334   Candidate.Viable = true;
6335   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6336       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO);
6337   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6338   Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
6339   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6340   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6341 
6342   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
6343   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
6344   // to them in diagnostics.
6345   if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) {
6346     Candidate.Viable = false;
6347     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
6348     return;
6349   }
6350 
6351   if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6352       !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6353     Candidate.Viable = false;
6354     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6355     return;
6356   }
6357 
6358   if (Constructor) {
6359     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
6360     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
6361     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
6362     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
6363     if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
6364         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
6365          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(),
6366                        ClassType))) {
6367       Candidate.Viable = false;
6368       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor;
6369       return;
6370     }
6371 
6372     // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution)
6373     //   A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter
6374     //   of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated
6375     //   from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when
6376     //   constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly
6377     //   one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related
6378     //   to C.
6379     auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl());
6380     if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 &&
6381         Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6382       QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType();
6383       QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent());
6384       QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent());
6385       SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc();
6386       if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) &&
6387           (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) {
6388         Candidate.Viable = false;
6389         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice;
6390         return;
6391       }
6392     }
6393 
6394     // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the
6395     // destination address space.
6396     if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(
6397             Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(),
6398             CandidateSet.getDestAS())) {
6399       Candidate.Viable = false;
6400       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch;
6401     }
6402   }
6403 
6404   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6405 
6406   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6407   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6408   // list (8.3.5).
6409   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6410       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6411     Candidate.Viable = false;
6412     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6413     return;
6414   }
6415 
6416   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6417   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6418   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6419   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6420   // exactly m parameters.
6421   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
6422   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6423     // Not enough arguments.
6424     Candidate.Viable = false;
6425     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6426     return;
6427   }
6428 
6429   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6430   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6431     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6432       // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this
6433       // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is
6434       // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of
6435       // the class.
6436       if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) {
6437         Candidate.Viable = false;
6438         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6439         return;
6440       }
6441 
6442   if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6443     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6444     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) ||
6445         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6446       Candidate.Viable = false;
6447       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6448       return;
6449     }
6450   }
6451 
6452   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6453   // arguments.
6454   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6455     unsigned ConvIdx =
6456         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx;
6457     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6458       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6459       // template argument deduction.
6460     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6461       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6462       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6463       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6464       // parameter of F.
6465       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6466       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
6467           *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions,
6468           /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6469           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6470           getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions);
6471       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6472         Candidate.Viable = false;
6473         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6474         return;
6475       }
6476     } else {
6477       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6478       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6479       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6480       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6481     }
6482   }
6483 
6484   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6485           CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) {
6486     Candidate.Viable = false;
6487     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6488     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6489     return;
6490   }
6491 
6492   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) {
6493     Candidate.Viable = false;
6494     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled;
6495     return;
6496   }
6497 }
6498 
6499 ObjCMethodDecl *
6500 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance,
6501                        SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) {
6502   if (Methods.size() <= 1)
6503     return nullptr;
6504 
6505   for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6506     bool Match = true;
6507     ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
6508     unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
6509     // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
6510     // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
6511     if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
6512       NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
6513     if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
6514       continue;
6515 
6516     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
6517       // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
6518       if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6519         Match = false;
6520         break;
6521       }
6522 
6523       ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
6524       Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
6525       assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
6526 
6527       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
6528       // a consumed argument.
6529       if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
6530           !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
6531         argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
6532 
6533       // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
6534       if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6535         Match = false;
6536         break;
6537       }
6538 
6539       ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
6540         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
6541                                 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
6542                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6543                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6544                                 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6545                                 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
6546       // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider
6547       // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here.
6548       if (ConversionState.isBad() ||
6549           (ConversionState.isStandard() &&
6550            ConversionState.Standard.Second ==
6551                ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) {
6552         Match = false;
6553         break;
6554       }
6555     }
6556     // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
6557     if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
6558       for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
6559         if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6560           Match = false;
6561           break;
6562         }
6563         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
6564                                                           nullptr);
6565         if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
6566           Match = false;
6567           break;
6568         }
6569       }
6570     } else {
6571       // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
6572       if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
6573         Match = false;
6574       else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
6575         // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
6576         // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
6577         for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6578           QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
6579           if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
6580             return Methods[b];
6581         }
6582       }
6583     }
6584 
6585     if (Match)
6586       return Method;
6587   }
6588   return nullptr;
6589 }
6590 
6591 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6592     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc,
6593     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis,
6594     Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) {
6595   if (ThisArg) {
6596     CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
6597     assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6598            "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!");
6599     assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!");
6600     ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(
6601         ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method);
6602     if (R.isInvalid())
6603       return false;
6604     ConvertedThis = R.get();
6605   } else {
6606     if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6607       (void)MD;
6608       assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() ||
6609               isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) &&
6610              "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods");
6611     }
6612     ConvertedThis = nullptr;
6613   }
6614 
6615   // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the
6616   // user can't refer to them in the function condition.
6617   unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size());
6618 
6619   // Convert the arguments.
6620   for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) {
6621     ExprResult R;
6622     R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6623                                         S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)),
6624                                     SourceLocation(), Args[I]);
6625 
6626     if (R.isInvalid())
6627       return false;
6628 
6629     ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6630   }
6631 
6632   if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6633     return false;
6634 
6635   // Push default arguments if needed.
6636   if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) {
6637     for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
6638       ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i);
6639       if (!P->hasDefaultArg())
6640         return false;
6641       ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P);
6642       if (R.isInvalid())
6643         return false;
6644       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6645     }
6646 
6647     if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6648       return false;
6649   }
6650   return true;
6651 }
6652 
6653 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function,
6654                                   SourceLocation CallLoc,
6655                                   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6656                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
6657   auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6658   if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end())
6659     return nullptr;
6660 
6661   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
6662   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
6663   // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed.
6664   Expr *DiscardedThis;
6665   if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6666           *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap,
6667           /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs))
6668     return *EnableIfAttrs.begin();
6669 
6670   for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) {
6671     APValue Result;
6672     // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is
6673     // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully.
6674     if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
6675         !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6676             Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs)))
6677       return EIA;
6678 
6679     if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue())
6680       return EIA;
6681   }
6682   return nullptr;
6683 }
6684 
6685 template <typename CheckFn>
6686 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND,
6687                                         bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc,
6688                                         CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) {
6689   SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs;
6690   for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) {
6691     if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent())
6692       Attrs.push_back(DIA);
6693   }
6694 
6695   // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early.
6696   if (Attrs.empty())
6697     return false;
6698 
6699   auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition(
6700       Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
6701       [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); });
6702 
6703   // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the
6704   // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes).
6705   auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin),
6706                                IsSuccessful);
6707   if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) {
6708     const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr;
6709     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6710     S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6711         << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6712     return true;
6713   }
6714 
6715   for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end()))
6716     if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) {
6717       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6718       S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6719           << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6720     }
6721 
6722   return false;
6723 }
6724 
6725 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function,
6726                                                const Expr *ThisArg,
6727                                                ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
6728                                                SourceLocation Loc) {
6729   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6730       *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc,
6731       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6732         APValue Result;
6733         // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since
6734         // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each
6735         // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to.
6736         if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6737                 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg))
6738           return false;
6739         return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue();
6740       });
6741 }
6742 
6743 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND,
6744                                                  SourceLocation Loc) {
6745   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6746       *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc,
6747       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6748         bool Result;
6749         return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) &&
6750                Result;
6751       });
6752 }
6753 
6754 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
6755 /// the overload candidate set.
6756 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
6757                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6758                                  OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6759                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6760                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6761                                  bool PartialOverloading,
6762                                  bool FirstArgumentIsBase) {
6763   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
6764     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
6765     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
6766 
6767     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6768     FunctionDecl *FD =
6769         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
6770 
6771     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) {
6772       QualType ObjectType;
6773       Expr::Classification ObjectClassification;
6774       if (Args.size() > 0) {
6775         if (Expr *E = Args[0]) {
6776           // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup:
6777           ObjectType = E->getType();
6778           // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we
6779           // always classify them as l-values.
6780           if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType())
6781             ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
6782           else
6783             ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context);
6784         } // .. else there is an implicit base.
6785         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6786       }
6787       if (FunTmpl) {
6788         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
6789             FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6790             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
6791             ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6792             FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6793             PartialOverloading);
6794       } else {
6795         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
6796                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType,
6797                            ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6798                            SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6799       }
6800     } else {
6801       // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods.
6802 
6803       // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access
6804       // static method as non-static.
6805       if (Args.size() > 0 &&
6806           (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
6807                         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) {
6808         assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic());
6809         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6810       }
6811       if (FunTmpl) {
6812         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6813                                      ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs,
6814                                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6815                                      PartialOverloading);
6816       } else {
6817         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6818                              SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6819       }
6820     }
6821   }
6822 }
6823 
6824 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
6825 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
6826 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType,
6827                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6828                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6829                               OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6830                               bool SuppressUserConversions,
6831                               OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6832   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6833   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
6834 
6835   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
6836     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
6837 
6838   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
6839     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6840            "Expected a member function template");
6841     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6842                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType,
6843                                ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6844                                SuppressUserConversions, false, PO);
6845   } else {
6846     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6847                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6848                        SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO);
6849   }
6850 }
6851 
6852 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
6853 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
6854 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
6855 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
6856 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
6857 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
6858 /// operators.
6859 void
6860 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6861                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6862                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6863                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6864                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6865                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
6866                          bool PartialOverloading,
6867                          ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6868                          OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6869   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6870     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6871   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6872   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6873          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
6874 
6875   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO))
6876     return;
6877 
6878   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
6879   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
6880   //   ignored by overload resolution.
6881   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
6882       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6883     return;
6884 
6885   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6886   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6887       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6888 
6889   // Add this candidate
6890   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6891       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions);
6892   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6893   Candidate.Function = Method;
6894   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6895       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO);
6896   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6897   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6898   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6899 
6900   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6901 
6902   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6903   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6904   // list (8.3.5).
6905   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6906       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6907     Candidate.Viable = false;
6908     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6909     return;
6910   }
6911 
6912   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6913   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6914   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6915   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6916   // exactly m parameters.
6917   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
6918   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6919     // Not enough arguments.
6920     Candidate.Viable = false;
6921     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6922     return;
6923   }
6924 
6925   Candidate.Viable = true;
6926 
6927   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
6928     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
6929     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
6930   else {
6931     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
6932     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
6933     // parameter.
6934     Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6935         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6936         Method, ActingContext);
6937     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6938       Candidate.Viable = false;
6939       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6940       return;
6941     }
6942   }
6943 
6944   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6945   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6946     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6947       if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) {
6948         Candidate.Viable = false;
6949         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6950         return;
6951       }
6952 
6953   if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6954     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6955     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) ||
6956         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6957       Candidate.Viable = false;
6958       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6959       return;
6960     }
6961   }
6962 
6963   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6964   // arguments.
6965   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6966     unsigned ConvIdx =
6967         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1);
6968     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6969       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6970       // template argument deduction.
6971     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6972       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6973       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6974       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6975       // parameter of F.
6976       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6977       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx]
6978         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6979                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6980                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6981                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6982                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6983       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6984         Candidate.Viable = false;
6985         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6986         return;
6987       }
6988     } else {
6989       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6990       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6991       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6992       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6993     }
6994   }
6995 
6996   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6997           CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) {
6998     Candidate.Viable = false;
6999     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7000     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7001     return;
7002   }
7003 
7004   if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
7005       !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
7006     Candidate.Viable = false;
7007     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7008   }
7009 }
7010 
7011 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
7012 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
7013 /// function template specialization.
7014 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
7015     FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7016     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7017     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType,
7018     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7019     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7020     bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7021   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO))
7022     return;
7023 
7024   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7025   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7026   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7027   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7028   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7029   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7030   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7031   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7032   //   functions.
7033   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7034   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7035   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7036   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7037           MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7038           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7039             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7040                 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7041                 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType,
7042                 ObjectClassification, PO);
7043           })) {
7044     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7045         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7046     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7047     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
7048     Candidate.Viable = false;
7049     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7050       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7051     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7052     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7053         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() ||
7054         ObjectType.isNull();
7055     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7056     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7057       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7058     else {
7059       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7060       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7061                                                             Info);
7062     }
7063     return;
7064   }
7065 
7066   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7067   // deduction as a candidate.
7068   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
7069   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
7070          "Specialization is not a member function?");
7071   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
7072                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
7073                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading,
7074                      Conversions, PO);
7075 }
7076 
7077 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier
7078 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true.
7079 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) {
7080   return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit();
7081 }
7082 
7083 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
7084 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
7085 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
7086 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7087     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7088     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7089     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7090     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate,
7091     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7092   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO))
7093     return;
7094 
7095   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7096   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7097   // and substitution in this case.
7098   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7099     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7100     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7101     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7102     Candidate.Viable = false;
7103     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7104     return;
7105   }
7106 
7107   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7108   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7109   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7110   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7111   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7112   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7113   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7114   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7115   //   functions.
7116   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7117   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7118   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7119   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7120           FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7121           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7122             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7123                 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7124                 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO);
7125           })) {
7126     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7127         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7128     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7129     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7130     Candidate.Viable = false;
7131     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7132       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7133     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7134     Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
7135     // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object
7136     // type.
7137     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7138         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) &&
7139         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function);
7140     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7141     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7142       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7143     else {
7144       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7145       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7146                                                             Info);
7147     }
7148     return;
7149   }
7150 
7151   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7152   // deduction as a candidate.
7153   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7154   AddOverloadCandidate(
7155       Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
7156       PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit,
7157       /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO);
7158 }
7159 
7160 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument
7161 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's
7162 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10.
7163 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions(
7164     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes,
7165     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7166     ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7167     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
7168     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7169   // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor
7170   // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear
7171   // that is correct.
7172   const bool AllowExplicit = false;
7173 
7174   auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7175   auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
7176   bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method);
7177   unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0;
7178 
7179   Conversions =
7180       CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size());
7181 
7182   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7183   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7184       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7185 
7186   // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't
7187   // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and
7188   // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations.
7189   if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() &&
7190       !ObjectType.isNull()) {
7191     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
7192     Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7193         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
7194         Method, ActingContext);
7195     if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7196       return true;
7197   }
7198 
7199   for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N;
7200        ++I) {
7201     QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I];
7202     if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) {
7203       unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed
7204                              ? 0
7205                              : (ThisConversions + I);
7206       Conversions[ConvIdx]
7207         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType,
7208                                 SuppressUserConversions,
7209                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7210                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7211                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
7212                                 AllowExplicit);
7213       if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7214         return true;
7215     }
7216   }
7217 
7218   return false;
7219 }
7220 
7221 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
7222 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
7223 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
7224 ///
7225 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
7226 ///
7227 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
7228 ///
7229 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
7230 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
7231 ///
7232 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
7233 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
7234                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
7235                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
7236   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
7237 
7238   // Easy case: the types are the same.
7239   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
7240     return true;
7241 
7242   // Allow qualification conversions.
7243   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
7244   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
7245                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
7246     return true;
7247 
7248   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
7249   // we're done.
7250   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
7251     return false;
7252 
7253   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
7254   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
7255   QualType ConvertedType;
7256   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
7257                                    IncompatibleObjC);
7258 }
7259 
7260 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
7261 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
7262 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
7263 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
7264 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
7265 /// conversion function produces).
7266 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate(
7267     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7268     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7269     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7270     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7271   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
7272          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
7273   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7274   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7275     return;
7276 
7277   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
7278   // deduction now.
7279   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
7280     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
7281       return;
7282     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7283   }
7284 
7285   // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion
7286   // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T.
7287   if (!AllowResultConversion &&
7288       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType))
7289     return;
7290 
7291   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
7292   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
7293   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
7294   //
7295   // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we
7296   // can't select them.
7297   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
7298       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
7299                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
7300     return;
7301 
7302   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7303   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7304       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7305 
7306   // Add this candidate
7307   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
7308   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7309   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
7310   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7311   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7312   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
7313   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
7314   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
7315   Candidate.Viable = true;
7316   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7317 
7318   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
7319   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
7320   // to them in diagnostics.
7321   if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) {
7322     Candidate.Viable = false;
7323     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7324     return;
7325   }
7326 
7327   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
7328   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
7329   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
7330   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
7331   //
7332   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7333   // object parameter.
7334   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
7335   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
7336     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
7337   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
7338     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
7339 
7340   Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7341       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(),
7342       From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext);
7343 
7344   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
7345     Candidate.Viable = false;
7346     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7347     return;
7348   }
7349 
7350   if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
7351     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
7352     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) ||
7353         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
7354       Candidate.Viable = false;
7355       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
7356       return;
7357     }
7358   }
7359 
7360   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
7361   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
7362   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
7363   QualType FromCanon
7364     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
7365   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
7366   if (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
7367       IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
7368     Candidate.Viable = false;
7369     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
7370     return;
7371   }
7372 
7373   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
7374   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
7375   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
7376   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
7377   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
7378   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
7379   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
7380   // well-formed.
7381   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
7382                             VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc());
7383   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
7384                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
7385                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef,
7386                                 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride());
7387 
7388   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
7389   if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) {
7390     Candidate.Viable = false;
7391     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7392     return;
7393   }
7394 
7395   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
7396 
7397   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
7398   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
7399   // allocator).
7400   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7401 
7402   alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)];
7403   CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary(
7404       Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc());
7405 
7406   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
7407       TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType,
7408                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
7409                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7410                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
7411 
7412   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
7413   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
7414     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
7415 
7416     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
7417     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
7418     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
7419     //   shall have exact match rank.
7420     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
7421         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
7422       Candidate.Viable = false;
7423       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
7424       return;
7425     }
7426 
7427     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
7428     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
7429     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
7430     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
7431     //    program is ill-formed.
7432     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
7433         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
7434       Candidate.Viable = false;
7435       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7436       return;
7437     }
7438     break;
7439 
7440   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
7441     Candidate.Viable = false;
7442     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7443     return;
7444 
7445   default:
7446     llvm_unreachable(
7447            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
7448   }
7449 
7450   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7451           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7452     Candidate.Viable = false;
7453     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7454     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7455     return;
7456   }
7457 
7458   if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
7459       !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
7460     Candidate.Viable = false;
7461     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7462   }
7463 }
7464 
7465 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization
7466 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
7467 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
7468 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
7469 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
7470 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
7471     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7472     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7473     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7474     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7475   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
7476          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
7477 
7478   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
7479     return;
7480 
7481   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7482   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7483   // and substitution in this case.
7484   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7485     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7486     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7487     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7488     Candidate.Viable = false;
7489     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7490     return;
7491   }
7492 
7493   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7494   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7495   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7496         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
7497                                   Specialization, Info)) {
7498     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7499     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7500     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7501     Candidate.Viable = false;
7502     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7503     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7504     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7505     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7506     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7507                                                           Info);
7508     return;
7509   }
7510 
7511   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
7512   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
7513   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7514   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
7515                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7516                          AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion);
7517 }
7518 
7519 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
7520 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
7521 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
7522 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
7523 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
7524 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
7525                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7526                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7527                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
7528                                  Expr *Object,
7529                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7530                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
7531   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7532     return;
7533 
7534   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7535   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7536       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7537 
7538   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
7539   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7540   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7541   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
7542   Candidate.Viable = true;
7543   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
7544   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7545   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7546 
7547   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7548   // object parameter.
7549   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7550       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(),
7551       Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext);
7552   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
7553     Candidate.Viable = false;
7554     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7555     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
7556     return;
7557   }
7558 
7559   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
7560   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
7561   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
7562   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
7563   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
7564   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
7565   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
7566   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
7567   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
7568   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
7569     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
7570   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
7571 
7572   // Find the
7573   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
7574 
7575   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
7576   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
7577   // list (8.3.5).
7578   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
7579     Candidate.Viable = false;
7580     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
7581     return;
7582   }
7583 
7584   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
7585   // we have enough arguments.
7586   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
7587     // Not enough arguments.
7588     Candidate.Viable = false;
7589     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
7590     return;
7591   }
7592 
7593   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7594   // arguments.
7595   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7596     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
7597       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
7598       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
7599       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
7600       // parameter of F.
7601       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
7602       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
7603         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
7604                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7605                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7606                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7607                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7608       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
7609         Candidate.Viable = false;
7610         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7611         return;
7612       }
7613     } else {
7614       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
7615       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
7616       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
7617       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
7618     }
7619   }
7620 
7621   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7622           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7623     Candidate.Viable = false;
7624     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7625     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7626     return;
7627   }
7628 }
7629 
7630 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given
7631 /// function set to the overload candidate set.
7632 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(
7633     const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7634     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7635     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
7636   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
7637     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
7638     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
7639 
7640     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
7641     FunctionDecl *FD =
7642         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
7643 
7644     // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting.
7645     if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD))
7646       continue;
7647 
7648     assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
7649            "unqualified operator lookup found a member function");
7650 
7651     if (FunTmpl) {
7652       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7653                                    FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7654       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7655         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7656             FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7657             {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false,
7658             true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7659     } else {
7660       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7661         continue;
7662       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7663       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7664         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(),
7665                              {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet,
7666                              false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL,
7667                              None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7668     }
7669   }
7670 }
7671 
7672 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
7673 /// member functions.
7674 ///
7675 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
7676 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
7677 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
7678 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
7679 /// [over.match.oper]).
7680 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7681                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
7682                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7683                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7684                                        OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7685   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7686 
7687   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7688   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
7689   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
7690   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
7691   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
7692   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
7693   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
7694   //   constructed as follows:
7695   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
7696 
7697   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
7698   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
7699   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
7700   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
7701   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7702     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
7703     if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined())
7704       return;
7705     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
7706     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
7707       return;
7708 
7709     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7710     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
7711     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
7712 
7713     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
7714                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
7715          Oper != OperEnd;
7716          ++Oper)
7717       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
7718                          Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
7719                          CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO);
7720   }
7721 }
7722 
7723 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
7724 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
7725 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
7726 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
7727 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
7728 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
7729 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
7730 /// converted to bool.
7731 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7732                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
7733                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
7734                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7735   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7736   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7737       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7738 
7739   // Add this candidate
7740   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
7741   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
7742   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7743   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7744   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7745   std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes);
7746 
7747   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7748   // arguments.
7749   Candidate.Viable = true;
7750   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7751   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7752     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
7753     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
7754     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
7755     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
7756     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
7757     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
7758     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
7759     //
7760     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
7761     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
7762     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
7763     // is not of the same type.
7764     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7765       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
7766              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
7767       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7768         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
7769     } else {
7770       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7771         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
7772                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
7773                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7774                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7775                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7776     }
7777     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
7778       Candidate.Viable = false;
7779       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7780       break;
7781     }
7782   }
7783 }
7784 
7785 namespace {
7786 
7787 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
7788 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
7789 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
7790 /// enumeration types.
7791 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
7792   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
7793   typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>,
7794                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet;
7795 
7796   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
7797   /// built-in candidates.
7798   TypeSet PointerTypes;
7799 
7800   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
7801   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7802   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
7803 
7804   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
7805   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7806   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
7807 
7808   /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
7809   /// candidates.
7810   TypeSet VectorTypes;
7811 
7812   /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in
7813   /// candidates.
7814   TypeSet MatrixTypes;
7815 
7816   /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
7817   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
7818 
7819   /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
7820   /// were present in the candidate set.
7821   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
7822 
7823   /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
7824   /// candidate set.
7825   bool HasNullPtrType;
7826 
7827   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
7828   /// candidate type set.
7829   Sema &SemaRef;
7830 
7831   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
7832   ASTContext &Context;
7833 
7834   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7835                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
7836   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
7837 
7838 public:
7839   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
7840   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
7841 
7842   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
7843     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
7844       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
7845       HasNullPtrType(false),
7846       SemaRef(SemaRef),
7847       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
7848 
7849   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7850                              SourceLocation Loc,
7851                              bool AllowUserConversions,
7852                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7853                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
7854 
7855   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> pointer_types() { return PointerTypes; }
7856   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> member_pointer_types() {
7857     return MemberPointerTypes;
7858   }
7859   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> enumeration_types() {
7860     return EnumerationTypes;
7861   }
7862   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; }
7863   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; }
7864 
7865   bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); }
7866   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
7867   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
7868   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
7869 };
7870 
7871 } // end anonymous namespace
7872 
7873 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
7874 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7875 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7876 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7877 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7878 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7879 /// false otherwise.
7880 ///
7881 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7882 bool
7883 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7884                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7885 
7886   // Insert this type.
7887   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7888     return false;
7889 
7890   QualType PointeeTy;
7891   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
7892   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
7893   if (!PointerTy) {
7894     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7895     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7896     buildObjCPtr = true;
7897   } else {
7898     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7899   }
7900 
7901   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7902   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7903   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7904   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7905   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7906     return true;
7907 
7908   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7909   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
7910   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
7911 
7912   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
7913   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7914     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7915     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
7916     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
7917 
7918     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
7919     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
7920     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
7921         (!hasRestrict ||
7922          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
7923       continue;
7924 
7925     // Build qualified pointee type.
7926     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7927 
7928     // Build qualified pointer type.
7929     QualType QPointerTy;
7930     if (!buildObjCPtr)
7931       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7932     else
7933       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7934 
7935     // Insert qualified pointer type.
7936     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
7937   }
7938 
7939   return true;
7940 }
7941 
7942 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
7943 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7944 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7945 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7946 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7947 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7948 /// false otherwise.
7949 ///
7950 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7951 bool
7952 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
7953     QualType Ty) {
7954   // Insert this type.
7955   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7956     return false;
7957 
7958   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
7959   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
7960 
7961   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7962   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7963   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7964   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7965   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7966   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7967     return true;
7968   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
7969 
7970   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
7971   // qualifiers.
7972   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7973   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7974     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7975 
7976     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7977     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
7978       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
7979   }
7980 
7981   return true;
7982 }
7983 
7984 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
7985 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
7986 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
7987 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
7988 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
7989 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
7990 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
7991 /// type.
7992 void
7993 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7994                                                SourceLocation Loc,
7995                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
7996                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7997                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7998   // Only deal with canonical types.
7999   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
8000 
8001   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
8002   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
8003   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8004     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
8005 
8006   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
8007   if (Ty->isArrayType())
8008     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
8009 
8010   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
8011   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
8012 
8013   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
8014   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
8015   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
8016 
8017   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
8018   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
8019     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
8020 
8021   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
8022     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
8023   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8024     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
8025     // of types.
8026     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
8027       return;
8028   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
8029     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
8030     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
8031       return;
8032   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
8033     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8034     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
8035   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
8036     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
8037     // extension.
8038     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8039     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
8040   } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) {
8041     // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in
8042     // many contexts as an extension.
8043     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8044     MatrixTypes.insert(Ty);
8045   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
8046     HasNullPtrType = true;
8047   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
8048     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
8049     if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty))
8050       return;
8051 
8052     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8053     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8054       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8055         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8056 
8057       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
8058       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
8059       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
8060         continue;
8061 
8062       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
8063       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
8064         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
8065                               VisibleQuals);
8066       }
8067     }
8068   }
8069 }
8070 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference
8071 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument.
8072 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
8073                                                         Expr *Arg) {
8074   return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace());
8075 }
8076 
8077 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
8078 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
8079 /// given type to the candidate set.
8080 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
8081                                                    QualType T,
8082                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8083                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
8084   QualType ParamTypes[2];
8085 
8086   // T& operator=(T&, T)
8087   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8088       AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0]));
8089   ParamTypes[1] = T;
8090   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8091                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8092 
8093   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
8094     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
8095     ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8096         AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T),
8097                                                 Args[0]));
8098     ParamTypes[1] = T;
8099     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8100                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8101   }
8102 }
8103 
8104 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
8105 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
8106 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
8107     Qualifiers VRQuals;
8108     const RecordType *TyRec;
8109     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
8110         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8111       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
8112     else
8113       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
8114     if (!TyRec) {
8115       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
8116       VRQuals.addVolatile();
8117       VRQuals.addRestrict();
8118       return VRQuals;
8119     }
8120 
8121     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8122     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
8123       return VRQuals;
8124 
8125     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8126       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8127         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8128       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
8129         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
8130         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8131           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8132         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
8133         // as see them.
8134         bool done = false;
8135         while (!done) {
8136           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
8137             VRQuals.addRestrict();
8138           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8139             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8140           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
8141                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8142             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
8143           else
8144             done = true;
8145           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
8146             VRQuals.addVolatile();
8147           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
8148             return VRQuals;
8149         }
8150       }
8151     }
8152     return VRQuals;
8153 }
8154 
8155 namespace {
8156 
8157 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
8158 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
8159 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
8160 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
8161 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
8162   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
8163   Sema &S;
8164   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
8165   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8166   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
8167   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
8168   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
8169 
8170   static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24;
8171   SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes;
8172 
8173   // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in
8174   // ArithmeticTypes.  The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
8175   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
8176   unsigned FirstIntegralType,
8177            LastIntegralType;
8178   unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType,
8179            LastPromotedIntegralType;
8180   unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType,
8181            LastPromotedArithmeticType;
8182   unsigned NumArithmeticTypes;
8183 
8184   void InitArithmeticTypes() {
8185     // Start of promoted types.
8186     FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0;
8187     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy);
8188     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy);
8189     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy);
8190     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type())
8191       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty);
8192 
8193     // Start of integral types.
8194     FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8195     FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8196     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy);
8197     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy);
8198     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy);
8199     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ||
8200         (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() &&
8201          S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type()))
8202       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty);
8203     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy);
8204     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy);
8205     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy);
8206     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ||
8207         (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() &&
8208          S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type()))
8209       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty);
8210     LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8211     LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8212     // End of promoted types.
8213 
8214     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy);
8215     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy);
8216     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy);
8217     if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8)
8218       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty);
8219     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty);
8220     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty);
8221     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy);
8222     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy);
8223     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy);
8224     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy);
8225     LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8226     NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8227     // End of integral types.
8228     // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
8229 
8230     assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap &&
8231            "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types.");
8232   }
8233 
8234   /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
8235   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
8236   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
8237                                            bool HasVolatile,
8238                                            bool HasRestrict) {
8239     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8240       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
8241       S.Context.IntTy
8242     };
8243 
8244     // Non-volatile version.
8245     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8246 
8247     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
8248     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
8249     if (HasVolatile) {
8250       ParamTypes[0] =
8251         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8252           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
8253       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8254     }
8255 
8256     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
8257     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
8258     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
8259         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
8260       ParamTypes[0]
8261         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8262             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
8263       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8264 
8265       if (HasVolatile) {
8266         ParamTypes[0]
8267           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8268               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
8269                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8270                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8271         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8272       }
8273     }
8274 
8275   }
8276 
8277   /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L
8278   /// and \p R.
8279   void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) {
8280     QualType LandR[2] = {L, R};
8281     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8282   }
8283 
8284 public:
8285   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
8286     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8287     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
8288     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
8289     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
8290     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
8291     : S(S), Args(Args),
8292       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
8293       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
8294         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
8295       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
8296       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
8297 
8298     InitArithmeticTypes();
8299   }
8300 
8301   // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17.
8302   //
8303   // C++ [over.built]p3:
8304   //
8305   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8306   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8307   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8308   //
8309   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
8310   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
8311   //
8312   // C++ [over.built]p4:
8313   //
8314   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8315   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8316   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8317   //
8318   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
8319   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
8320   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8321     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8322       return;
8323 
8324     for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
8325       const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8326       if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) {
8327         if (Op == OO_MinusMinus)
8328           continue;
8329         if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)
8330           continue;
8331       }
8332       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8333         TypeOfT,
8334         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
8335         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
8336     }
8337   }
8338 
8339   // C++ [over.built]p5:
8340   //
8341   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8342   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
8343   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8344   //
8345   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
8346   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
8347   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
8348   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
8349   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
8350     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8351       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
8352       if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8353         continue;
8354 
8355       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8356           PtrTy,
8357           (!PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8358            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
8359           (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8360            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
8361     }
8362   }
8363 
8364   // C++ [over.built]p6:
8365   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
8366   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8367   //
8368   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8369   //
8370   // C++ [over.built]p7:
8371   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
8372   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8373   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8374   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
8375     for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8376       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
8377       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8378         continue;
8379 
8380       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
8381         if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
8382           continue;
8383 
8384       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8385     }
8386   }
8387 
8388   // C++ [over.built]p9:
8389   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
8390   //  operator functions of the form
8391   //
8392   //       T         operator+(T);
8393   //       T         operator-(T);
8394   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
8395     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8396       return;
8397 
8398     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8399          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
8400       QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8401       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8402     }
8403 
8404     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
8405     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8406       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8407   }
8408 
8409   // C++ [over.built]p8:
8410   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
8411   //   the form
8412   //
8413   //       T*         operator+(T*);
8414   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
8415     for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types())
8416       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8417   }
8418 
8419   // C++ [over.built]p10:
8420   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
8421   //   operator functions of the form
8422   //
8423   //        T         operator~(T);
8424   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
8425     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8426       return;
8427 
8428     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8429          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
8430       QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int];
8431       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8432     }
8433 
8434     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
8435     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8436       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8437   }
8438 
8439   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
8440   //   For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there
8441   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8442   //
8443   //        bool operator==(T,T);
8444   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
8445   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() {
8446     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8447     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8448 
8449     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8450       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
8451         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8452         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
8453           continue;
8454 
8455         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy};
8456         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8457       }
8458 
8459       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
8460         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
8461         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) {
8462           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
8463           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8464         }
8465       }
8466     }
8467   }
8468 
8469   // C++ [over.built]p15:
8470   //
8471   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type,
8472   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8473   //
8474   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
8475   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
8476   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
8477   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
8478   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
8479   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
8480   //           R       operator<=>(T, T)
8481   void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8482     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8483     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
8484     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
8485     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
8486     //   candidate.
8487     //
8488     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
8489     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
8490     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
8491     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
8492     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
8493     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
8494     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
8495       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
8496 
8497     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8498       if (!CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types().empty()) {
8499         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
8500                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8501              C != CEnd; ++C) {
8502           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
8503             continue;
8504 
8505           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
8506             continue;
8507 
8508           // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the
8509           // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters
8510           // reversed", not to the original function.
8511           bool Reversed = C->isReversed();
8512           QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0)
8513                                         ->getType()
8514                                         .getUnqualifiedType();
8515           QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1)
8516                                          ->getType()
8517                                          .getUnqualifiedType();
8518 
8519           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
8520           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
8521               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
8522             continue;
8523 
8524           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
8525           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
8526             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
8527                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
8528         }
8529       }
8530     }
8531 
8532     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8533     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8534 
8535     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8536       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) {
8537         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8538         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8539           continue;
8540 
8541         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
8542         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8543       }
8544       for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
8545         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy);
8546 
8547         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
8548         // candidate exists.
8549         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second ||
8550             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
8551                                                             CanonType)))
8552           continue;
8553         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy};
8554         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8555       }
8556     }
8557   }
8558 
8559   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8560   //
8561   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
8562   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8563   //
8564   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8565   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
8566   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8567   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8568   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
8569   //
8570   // C++ [over.built]p14:
8571   //
8572   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
8573   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8574   //
8575   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
8576   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8577     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8578     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8579 
8580     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
8581       QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = {
8582         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8583         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8584       };
8585       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_types()) {
8586         QualType PointeeTy = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
8587         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
8588           continue;
8589 
8590         AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = PtrTy;
8591         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
8592           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
8593           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8594           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8595         }
8596         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
8597           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
8598           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8599             continue;
8600 
8601           QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
8602           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8603         }
8604       }
8605     }
8606   }
8607 
8608   // C++ [over.built]p12:
8609   //
8610   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
8611   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8612   //
8613   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
8614   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
8615   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
8616   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
8617   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
8618   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
8619   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
8620   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
8621   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
8622   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
8623   //
8624   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8625   //   between types L and R.
8626   //
8627   // C++ [over.built]p24:
8628   //
8629   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
8630   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8631   //
8632   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
8633   //
8634   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8635   //   between types L and R.
8636   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
8637   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8638     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8639       return;
8640 
8641     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8642          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
8643       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8644            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8645         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8646                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8647         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8648       }
8649     }
8650 
8651     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
8652     // conditional operator for vector types.
8653     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8654       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) {
8655         QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty};
8656         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8657       }
8658   }
8659 
8660   /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2:
8661   ///  * (M1, M1) -> M1
8662   ///  * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1
8663   ///  * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2
8664   ///  * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0].
8665   void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8666     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8667       return;
8668 
8669     for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) {
8670       AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType());
8671       AddCandidate(M1, M1);
8672     }
8673 
8674     for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) {
8675       AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2);
8676       if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2))
8677         AddCandidate(M2, M2);
8678     }
8679   }
8680 
8681   // C++2a [over.built]p14:
8682   //
8683   //   For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function
8684   //   of the form
8685   //
8686   //        std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T)
8687   //
8688   // C++2a [over.built]p15:
8689   //
8690   //   For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate
8691   //   operator function of the form
8692   //
8693   //       std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R);
8694   //
8695   // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with
8696   // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum
8697   // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during
8698   // overload resolution. For example:
8699   //
8700   //   enum A : int {a};
8701   //   auto x = (a <=> (long)42);
8702   //
8703   //   error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'.
8704   //   note: candidate operator<=>(int, int)
8705   //   note: candidate operator<=>(long, long)
8706   //
8707   // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds
8708   // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted
8709   // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads).
8710   //
8711   // For now this function acts as a placeholder.
8712   void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() {
8713     addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8714   }
8715 
8716   // C++ [over.built]p17:
8717   //
8718   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
8719   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8720   //
8721   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
8722   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
8723   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
8724   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
8725   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
8726   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
8727   //
8728   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8729   //   between types L and R.
8730   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8731     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8732       return;
8733 
8734     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8735          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
8736       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8737            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8738         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8739                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8740         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8741       }
8742     }
8743   }
8744 
8745   // C++ [over.built]p20:
8746   //
8747   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
8748   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
8749   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8750   //
8751   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
8752   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8753     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8754     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8755 
8756     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8757       for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
8758         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second)
8759           continue;
8760 
8761         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, EnumTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8762       }
8763 
8764       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
8765         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
8766           continue;
8767 
8768         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, MemPtrTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8769       }
8770     }
8771   }
8772 
8773   // C++ [over.built]p19:
8774   //
8775   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
8776   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
8777   //   of the form
8778   //
8779   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
8780   //
8781   // C++ [over.built]p21:
8782   //
8783   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8784   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
8785   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8786   //
8787   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8788   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8789   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8790     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8791     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8792 
8793     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8794       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
8795       if (isEqualOp)
8796         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy));
8797       else if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8798         continue;
8799 
8800       // non-volatile version
8801       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8802           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy),
8803           isEqualOp ? PtrTy : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8804       };
8805       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8806                             /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
8807 
8808       bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8809                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8810       if (NeedVolatile) {
8811         // volatile version
8812         ParamTypes[0] =
8813             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy));
8814         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8815                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8816       }
8817 
8818       if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8819           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8820         // restrict version
8821         ParamTypes[0] =
8822             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy));
8823         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8824                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8825 
8826         if (NeedVolatile) {
8827           // volatile restrict version
8828           ParamTypes[0] =
8829               S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(
8830                   PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8831           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8832                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8833         }
8834       }
8835     }
8836 
8837     if (isEqualOp) {
8838       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) {
8839         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
8840         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8841           continue;
8842 
8843         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8844             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy),
8845             PtrTy,
8846         };
8847 
8848         // non-volatile version
8849         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8850                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8851 
8852         bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8853                             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8854         if (NeedVolatile) {
8855           // volatile version
8856           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8857               S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy));
8858           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8859                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8860         }
8861 
8862         if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8863             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8864           // restrict version
8865           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8866               S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy));
8867           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8868                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8869 
8870           if (NeedVolatile) {
8871             // volatile restrict version
8872             ParamTypes[0] =
8873                 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(
8874                     PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8875             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8876                                   /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8877           }
8878         }
8879       }
8880     }
8881   }
8882 
8883   // C++ [over.built]p18:
8884   //
8885   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
8886   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
8887   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
8888   //   the form
8889   //
8890   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
8891   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
8892   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
8893   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
8894   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
8895   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8896     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8897       return;
8898 
8899     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
8900       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8901            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8902         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8903         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8904         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8905             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8906         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8907         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8908         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8909                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8910 
8911         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8912         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8913           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy);
8914           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8915           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8916                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8917         }
8918       }
8919     }
8920 
8921     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
8922     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8923       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) {
8924         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8925         ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty;
8926         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8927         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty);
8928         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8929                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8930 
8931         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8932         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8933           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty);
8934           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8935           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8936                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8937         }
8938       }
8939   }
8940 
8941   // C++ [over.built]p22:
8942   //
8943   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
8944   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
8945   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8946   //
8947   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
8948   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
8949   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
8950   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
8951   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
8952   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
8953   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
8954     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8955       return;
8956 
8957     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
8958       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8959            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8960         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8961         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8962         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8963             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8964         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8965         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8966         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8967         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8968           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8969           ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy;
8970           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
8971           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8972           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8973         }
8974       }
8975     }
8976   }
8977 
8978   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
8979   //
8980   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
8981   //
8982   //        bool        operator!(bool);
8983   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
8984   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
8985   void addExclaimOverload() {
8986     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
8987     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
8988                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8989                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
8990   }
8991   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
8992     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
8993     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8994                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8995                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
8996   }
8997 
8998   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8999   //
9000   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
9001   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
9002   //
9003   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
9004   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
9005   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
9006   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
9007   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
9008   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
9009     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
9010       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, S.Context.getPointerDiffType()};
9011       QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
9012       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9013         continue;
9014 
9015       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
9016       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9017     }
9018 
9019     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) {
9020       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), PtrTy};
9021       QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
9022       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9023         continue;
9024 
9025       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
9026       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9027     }
9028   }
9029 
9030   // C++ [over.built]p11:
9031   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
9032   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
9033   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
9034   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9035   //
9036   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
9037   //
9038   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
9039   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
9040     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
9041       QualType C1Ty = PtrTy;
9042       QualType C1;
9043       QualifierCollector Q1;
9044       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
9045       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
9046         continue;
9047       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
9048       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
9049       // volatile/restrict type.
9050       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
9051         continue;
9052       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
9053         continue;
9054       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_types()) {
9055         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(MemPtrTy);
9056         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
9057         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
9058         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2))
9059           break;
9060         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, MemPtrTy};
9061         // build CV12 T&
9062         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
9063         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
9064             T.isVolatileQualified())
9065           continue;
9066         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
9067             T.isRestrictQualified())
9068           continue;
9069         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
9070         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9071       }
9072     }
9073   }
9074 
9075   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
9076   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
9077   // therefore added as binary.
9078   //
9079   // C++ [over.built]p25:
9080   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
9081   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9082   //
9083   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
9084   //
9085   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
9086     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
9087     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
9088 
9089     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
9090       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) {
9091         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
9092           continue;
9093 
9094         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
9095         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9096       }
9097 
9098       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
9099         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
9100           continue;
9101 
9102         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy};
9103         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9104       }
9105 
9106       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
9107         for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
9108           if (!EnumTy->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
9109             continue;
9110 
9111           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second)
9112             continue;
9113 
9114           QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy};
9115           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9116         }
9117       }
9118     }
9119   }
9120 };
9121 
9122 } // end anonymous namespace
9123 
9124 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
9125 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
9126 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
9127 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
9128 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
9129 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9130                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
9131                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9132                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
9133   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
9134   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
9135   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
9136   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
9137   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
9138   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
9139   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
9140     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
9141 
9142   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
9143   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
9144   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
9145   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
9146     CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this);
9147     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
9148                                                  OpLoc,
9149                                                  true,
9150                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
9151                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
9152                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
9153                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
9154     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
9155         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
9156     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
9157         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
9158         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
9159   }
9160 
9161   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
9162   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
9163   //
9164   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
9165   // 'bool' overloads.
9166   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
9167       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
9168     return;
9169 
9170   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
9171   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
9172                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
9173                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
9174                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
9175 
9176   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
9177   switch (Op) {
9178   case OO_None:
9179   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
9180     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
9181 
9182   case OO_New:
9183   case OO_Delete:
9184   case OO_Array_New:
9185   case OO_Array_Delete:
9186   case OO_Call:
9187     llvm_unreachable(
9188                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
9189 
9190   case OO_Comma:
9191   case OO_Arrow:
9192   case OO_Coawait:
9193     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9194     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the
9195     //      operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the
9196     //      built-in candidates set is empty.
9197     break;
9198 
9199   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
9200     if (Args.size() == 1)
9201       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
9202     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9203 
9204   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
9205     if (Args.size() == 1) {
9206       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
9207     } else {
9208       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
9209       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9210       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9211     }
9212     break;
9213 
9214   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
9215     if (Args.size() == 1)
9216       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
9217     else {
9218       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9219       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9220     }
9221     break;
9222 
9223   case OO_Slash:
9224     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9225     break;
9226 
9227   case OO_PlusPlus:
9228   case OO_MinusMinus:
9229     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9230     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
9231     break;
9232 
9233   case OO_EqualEqual:
9234   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
9235     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads();
9236     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9237 
9238   case OO_Less:
9239   case OO_Greater:
9240   case OO_LessEqual:
9241   case OO_GreaterEqual:
9242     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9243     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9244     break;
9245 
9246   case OO_Spaceship:
9247     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9248     OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads();
9249     break;
9250 
9251   case OO_Percent:
9252   case OO_Caret:
9253   case OO_Pipe:
9254   case OO_LessLess:
9255   case OO_GreaterGreater:
9256     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9257     break;
9258 
9259   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
9260     if (Args.size() == 1)
9261       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9262       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
9263       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
9264       break;
9265 
9266     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9267     break;
9268 
9269   case OO_Tilde:
9270     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
9271     break;
9272 
9273   case OO_Equal:
9274     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9275     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9276 
9277   case OO_PlusEqual:
9278   case OO_MinusEqual:
9279     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9280     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9281 
9282   case OO_StarEqual:
9283   case OO_SlashEqual:
9284     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9285     break;
9286 
9287   case OO_PercentEqual:
9288   case OO_LessLessEqual:
9289   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
9290   case OO_AmpEqual:
9291   case OO_CaretEqual:
9292   case OO_PipeEqual:
9293     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
9294     break;
9295 
9296   case OO_Exclaim:
9297     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
9298     break;
9299 
9300   case OO_AmpAmp:
9301   case OO_PipePipe:
9302     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
9303     break;
9304 
9305   case OO_Subscript:
9306     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
9307     break;
9308 
9309   case OO_ArrowStar:
9310     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
9311     break;
9312 
9313   case OO_Conditional:
9314     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
9315     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9316     break;
9317   }
9318 }
9319 
9320 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
9321 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
9322 ///
9323 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
9324 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
9325 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
9326 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
9327 void
9328 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
9329                                            SourceLocation Loc,
9330                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9331                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9332                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
9333                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
9334   ADLResult Fns;
9335 
9336   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
9337   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
9338   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
9339   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
9340   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
9341   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
9342 
9343   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
9344   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
9345 
9346   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
9347   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
9348                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
9349        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
9350     if (Cand->Function) {
9351       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
9352       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
9353         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
9354     }
9355 
9356   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
9357   // set.
9358   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9359     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
9360 
9361     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
9362       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
9363         continue;
9364 
9365       AddOverloadCandidate(
9366           FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
9367           PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
9368           /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9369       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) {
9370         AddOverloadCandidate(
9371             FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
9372             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9373             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false,
9374             ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9375       }
9376     } else {
9377       auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I);
9378       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9379           FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
9380           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9381           /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9382       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(
9383               Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9384         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9385             FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]},
9386             CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9387             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL,
9388             OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9389       }
9390     }
9391   }
9392 }
9393 
9394 namespace {
9395 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse };
9396 }
9397 
9398 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of
9399 /// overload resolution.
9400 ///
9401 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff
9402 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as
9403 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if
9404 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes.
9405 ///
9406 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if
9407 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are
9408 /// worse than Cand1's.
9409 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1,
9410                                        const FunctionDecl *Cand2) {
9411   // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs.
9412   bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9413   bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9414   if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) {
9415     if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr)
9416       return Comparison::Equal;
9417     return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse;
9418   }
9419 
9420   auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9421   auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9422 
9423   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
9424   for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) {
9425     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair);
9426     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair);
9427 
9428     // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1
9429     // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa.
9430     if (!Cand1A)
9431       return Comparison::Worse;
9432     if (!Cand2A)
9433       return Comparison::Better;
9434 
9435     Cand1ID.clear();
9436     Cand2ID.clear();
9437 
9438     (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9439     (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9440     if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
9441       return Comparison::Worse;
9442   }
9443 
9444   return Comparison::Equal;
9445 }
9446 
9447 static Comparison
9448 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
9449                               const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) {
9450   if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function ||
9451       !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion())
9452     return Comparison::Equal;
9453 
9454   // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other
9455   // is better.
9456   if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) {
9457     if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9458       return Comparison::Equal;
9459     return Comparison::Worse;
9460   }
9461   if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9462     return Comparison::Better;
9463 
9464   // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer
9465   // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers.
9466   bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9467   bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9468   const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9469   const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9470 
9471   if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec)
9472     return Comparison::Equal;
9473 
9474   if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp)
9475     return Comparison::Better;
9476   if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp)
9477     return Comparison::Worse;
9478 
9479   if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) {
9480     if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size())
9481       return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()
9482                  ? Comparison::Better
9483                  : Comparison::Worse;
9484 
9485     std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator>
9486         FirstDiff = std::mismatch(
9487             Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(),
9488             Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
9489             [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) {
9490               return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName();
9491             });
9492 
9493     assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() &&
9494            "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same "
9495            "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!");
9496     return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName()
9497                ? Comparison::Better
9498                : Comparison::Worse;
9499   }
9500   llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch");
9501 }
9502 
9503 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function,
9504 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null
9505 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter.
9506 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context,
9507                                                      const FunctionDecl *F) {
9508   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F))
9509     return llvm::None;
9510 
9511   auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F);
9512   // Static member functions' object parameters match all types.
9513   if (M->isStatic())
9514     return QualType();
9515 
9516   QualType T = M->getThisObjectType();
9517   if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue)
9518     return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T);
9519   return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
9520 }
9521 
9522 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1,
9523                                    const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) {
9524   if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2))
9525     return true;
9526 
9527   auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) {
9528     if (First) {
9529       if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F))
9530         return *T;
9531     }
9532     assert(I < F->getNumParams());
9533     return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType();
9534   };
9535 
9536   unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0;
9537   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) {
9538     QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0);
9539     QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0);
9540     if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
9541       return false;
9542   }
9543   return true;
9544 }
9545 
9546 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
9547 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
9548 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(
9549     Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
9550     SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) {
9551   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
9552   // functions.
9553   if (!Cand2.Viable)
9554     return Cand1.Viable;
9555   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
9556     return false;
9557 
9558   // [CUDA] A function with 'never' preference is marked not viable, therefore
9559   // is never shown up here. The worst preference shown up here is 'wrong side',
9560   // e.g. an H function called by a HD function in device compilation. This is
9561   // valid AST as long as the HD function is not emitted, e.g. it is an inline
9562   // function which is called only by an H function. A deferred diagnostic will
9563   // be triggered if it is emitted. However a wrong-sided function is still
9564   // a viable candidate here.
9565   //
9566   // If Cand1 can be emitted and Cand2 cannot be emitted in the current
9567   // context, Cand1 is better than Cand2. If Cand1 can not be emitted and Cand2
9568   // can be emitted, Cand1 is not better than Cand2. This rule should have
9569   // precedence over other rules.
9570   //
9571   // If both Cand1 and Cand2 can be emitted, or neither can be emitted, then
9572   // other rules should be used to determine which is better. This is because
9573   // host/device based overloading resolution is mostly for determining
9574   // viability of a function. If two functions are both viable, other factors
9575   // should take precedence in preference, e.g. the standard-defined preferences
9576   // like argument conversion ranks or enable_if partial-ordering. The
9577   // preference for pass-object-size parameters is probably most similar to a
9578   // type-based-overloading decision and so should take priority.
9579   //
9580   // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference will be
9581   // used again to determine which is better.
9582   //
9583   // TODO: Currently IdentifyCUDAPreference does not return correct values
9584   // for functions called in global variable initializers due to missing
9585   // correct context about device/host. Therefore we can only enforce this
9586   // rule when there is a caller. We should enforce this rule for functions
9587   // in global variable initializers once proper context is added.
9588   //
9589   // TODO: We can only enable the hostness based overloading resolution when
9590   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on since this requires deferring
9591   // overloading resolution diagnostics.
9592   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9593       S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) {
9594     if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) {
9595       bool IsCallerImplicitHD = Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Caller);
9596       bool IsCand1ImplicitHD =
9597           Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand1.Function);
9598       bool IsCand2ImplicitHD =
9599           Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand2.Function);
9600       auto P1 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function);
9601       auto P2 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9602       assert(P1 != Sema::CFP_Never && P2 != Sema::CFP_Never);
9603       // The implicit HD function may be a function in a system header which
9604       // is forced by pragma. In device compilation, if we prefer HD candidates
9605       // over wrong-sided candidates, overloading resolution may change, which
9606       // may result in non-deferrable diagnostics. As a workaround, we let
9607       // implicit HD candidates take equal preference as wrong-sided candidates.
9608       // This will preserve the overloading resolution.
9609       // TODO: We still need special handling of implicit HD functions since
9610       // they may incur other diagnostics to be deferred. We should make all
9611       // host/device related diagnostics deferrable and remove special handling
9612       // of implicit HD functions.
9613       auto EmitThreshold =
9614           (S.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && IsCallerImplicitHD &&
9615            (IsCand1ImplicitHD || IsCand2ImplicitHD))
9616               ? Sema::CFP_Never
9617               : Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9618       auto Cand1Emittable = P1 > EmitThreshold;
9619       auto Cand2Emittable = P2 > EmitThreshold;
9620       if (Cand1Emittable && !Cand2Emittable)
9621         return true;
9622       if (!Cand1Emittable && Cand2Emittable)
9623         return false;
9624     }
9625   }
9626 
9627   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9628   //
9629   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
9630   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
9631   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
9632   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
9633   unsigned StartArg = 0;
9634   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
9635     StartArg = 1;
9636 
9637   auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
9638     // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++.
9639     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
9640       return ICS.isStandard() &&
9641              ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
9642 
9643     // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to
9644     // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11.
9645     return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
9646            hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS);
9647   };
9648 
9649   // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given
9650   // argument to be better candidates than functions that do.
9651   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
9652   assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
9653   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
9654   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9655     bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9656     bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9657     if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) {
9658       if (Cand1Bad)
9659         return false;
9660       HasBetterConversion = true;
9661     }
9662   }
9663 
9664   if (HasBetterConversion)
9665     return true;
9666 
9667   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9668   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
9669   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
9670   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
9671   bool HasWorseConversion = false;
9672   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9673     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9674                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
9675                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
9676     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9677       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
9678       HasBetterConversion = true;
9679       break;
9680 
9681     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9682       if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9683           Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() &&
9684           haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function,
9685                                  NumArgs)) {
9686         // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed
9687         // forms of operator== in C++20:
9688         //
9689         // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same
9690         // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and
9691         // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences
9692         // are treated as being equally good.
9693         //
9694         // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous
9695         // with a reversed form that is written in the same way.
9696         //
9697         // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp.
9698         HasWorseConversion = true;
9699         break;
9700       }
9701 
9702       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
9703       return false;
9704 
9705     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9706       // Do nothing.
9707       break;
9708     }
9709   }
9710 
9711   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
9712   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
9713   if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion)
9714     return true;
9715 
9716   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
9717   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
9718   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
9719   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
9720   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
9721   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
9722   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion &&
9723       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9724       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
9725       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
9726     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
9727     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
9728     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
9729     // pointer or block.
9730     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
9731         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9732     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9733       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9734                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
9735                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
9736 
9737     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9738       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
9739 
9740     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
9741     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
9742     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
9743   }
9744 
9745   // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording,
9746   // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243.
9747   //
9748   // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or
9749   // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over
9750   // a conversion function.
9751   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 &&
9752       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9753       isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) !=
9754           isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function))
9755     return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9756 
9757   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
9758   //       specialization, or, if not that,
9759   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
9760                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9761   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
9762                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9763   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
9764     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
9765 
9766   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
9767   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
9768   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
9769   //      if not that,
9770   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
9771     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(
9772             Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
9773             Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc,
9774             isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion
9775                                                    : TPOC_Call,
9776             Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments,
9777             Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed()))
9778       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9779   }
9780 
9781   //   -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same
9782   //      parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...],
9783   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization &&
9784       !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() &&
9785       Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) {
9786     auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType());
9787     auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType());
9788     if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() &&
9789         PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() &&
9790         S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) {
9791       Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9792       Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9793       if (RC1 && RC2) {
9794         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
9795         if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function,
9796                                      {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) ||
9797             S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function,
9798                                      {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
9799           return false;
9800         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2)
9801           return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
9802       } else if (RC1 || RC2) {
9803         return RC1 != nullptr;
9804       }
9805     }
9806   }
9807 
9808   //   -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base
9809   //      class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of
9810   //      F1 and F2 have the same type.
9811   // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check.
9812   bool Cand1IsInherited =
9813       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9814   bool Cand2IsInherited =
9815       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9816   if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited)
9817     return Cand2IsInherited;
9818   else if (Cand1IsInherited) {
9819     assert(Cand2IsInherited);
9820     auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext());
9821     auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext());
9822     if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class))
9823       return true;
9824     if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class))
9825       return false;
9826     // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous.
9827   }
9828 
9829   //   -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not
9830   //   -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate
9831   //      with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not
9832   //
9833   // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but
9834   // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for
9835   // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>).
9836   if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind)
9837     return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind;
9838 
9839   // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides.
9840   {
9841     auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9842     auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function);
9843     if (Guide1 && Guide2) {
9844       //  -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not
9845       if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit())
9846         return Guide2->isImplicit();
9847 
9848       //  -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not
9849       if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate())
9850         return true;
9851     }
9852   }
9853 
9854   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
9855   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9856     Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9857     if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal)
9858       return Cmp == Comparison::Better;
9859   }
9860 
9861   bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr &&
9862                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function);
9863   bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr &&
9864                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function);
9865   if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1)
9866     return true;
9867 
9868   auto MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2);
9869   if (MV == Comparison::Better)
9870     return true;
9871   if (MV == Comparison::Worse)
9872     return false;
9873 
9874   // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference is used
9875   // to determine which is better.
9876   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9877     FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9878     return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) >
9879            S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9880   }
9881 
9882   return false;
9883 }
9884 
9885 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of
9886 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no
9887 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including
9888 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to
9889 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both
9890 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using
9891 /// a modularized libstdc++).
9892 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
9893                                                   const NamedDecl *B) {
9894   auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A);
9895   auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B);
9896   if (!VA || !VB)
9897     return false;
9898 
9899   // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage
9900   // entity in different modules.
9901   if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
9902           VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) ||
9903       getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) ||
9904       VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible())
9905     return false;
9906 
9907   // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent.
9908   //
9909   // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity.
9910   // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is
9911   // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all.
9912   if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType()))
9913     return true;
9914 
9915   // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but
9916   // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes.
9917   if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) {
9918     if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) {
9919       // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and
9920       // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type.
9921       auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext());
9922       auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext());
9923       if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() ||
9924           !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(),
9925                                EnumB->getIntegerType()))
9926         return false;
9927       // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators.
9928       return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal());
9929     }
9930   }
9931 
9932   // Nothing else is sufficiently similar.
9933   return false;
9934 }
9935 
9936 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(
9937     SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) {
9938   Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D;
9939 
9940   Module *M = getOwningModule(D);
9941   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9942       << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9943 
9944   for (auto *E : Equiv) {
9945     Module *M = getOwningModule(E);
9946     Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9947         << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9948   }
9949 }
9950 
9951 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
9952 /// within an overload candidate set.
9953 ///
9954 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
9955 /// which overload resolution occurs.
9956 ///
9957 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
9958 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
9959 ///
9960 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
9961 OverloadingResult
9962 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9963                                          iterator &Best) {
9964   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates;
9965   std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates),
9966                  [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; });
9967 
9968   // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but
9969   // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular
9970   // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to
9971   // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based
9972   // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one
9973   // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore
9974   // the WrongSide candidate.
9975   // We only need to remove wrong-sided candidates here if
9976   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is off. When
9977   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on, all candidates are compared
9978   // uniformly in isBetterOverloadCandidate.
9979   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && !S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) {
9980     const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9981     bool ContainsSameSideCandidate =
9982         llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9983           // Check viable function only.
9984           return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9985                  S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9986                      Sema::CFP_SameSide;
9987         });
9988     if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) {
9989       auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9990         // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving.
9991         return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9992                S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9993                    Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9994       };
9995       llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate);
9996     }
9997   }
9998 
9999   // Find the best viable function.
10000   Best = end();
10001   for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
10002     Cand->Best = false;
10003     if (Cand->Viable)
10004       if (Best == end() ||
10005           isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind))
10006         Best = Cand;
10007   }
10008 
10009   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
10010   if (Best == end())
10011     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
10012 
10013   llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands;
10014 
10015   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest;
10016   PendingBest.push_back(&*Best);
10017   Best->Best = true;
10018 
10019   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
10020   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
10021   while (!PendingBest.empty()) {
10022     auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val();
10023     for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
10024       if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best &&
10025           !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) {
10026         PendingBest.push_back(Cand);
10027         Cand->Best = true;
10028 
10029         if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function,
10030                                                      Curr->Function))
10031           EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function);
10032         else
10033           Best = end();
10034       }
10035     }
10036   }
10037 
10038   // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous.
10039   if (Best == end())
10040     return OR_Ambiguous;
10041 
10042   // Best is the best viable function.
10043   if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted())
10044     return OR_Deleted;
10045 
10046   if (!EquivalentCands.empty())
10047     S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function,
10048                                                     EquivalentCands);
10049 
10050   return OR_Success;
10051 }
10052 
10053 namespace {
10054 
10055 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
10056   oc_function,
10057   oc_method,
10058   oc_reversed_binary_operator,
10059   oc_constructor,
10060   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
10061   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
10062   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
10063   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
10064   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
10065   oc_implicit_equality_comparison,
10066   oc_inherited_constructor
10067 };
10068 
10069 enum OverloadCandidateSelect {
10070   ocs_non_template,
10071   ocs_template,
10072   ocs_described_template,
10073 };
10074 
10075 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect>
10076 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10077                           OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK,
10078                           std::string &Description) {
10079 
10080   bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl();
10081   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
10082     isTemplate = true;
10083     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10084         FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
10085   }
10086 
10087   OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() {
10088     if (!Description.empty())
10089       return ocs_described_template;
10090     return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template;
10091   }();
10092 
10093   OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() {
10094     if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual)
10095       return oc_implicit_equality_comparison;
10096 
10097     if (CRK & CRK_Reversed)
10098       return oc_reversed_binary_operator;
10099 
10100     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10101       if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) {
10102         if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found))
10103           return oc_inherited_constructor;
10104         else
10105           return oc_constructor;
10106       }
10107 
10108       if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
10109         return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
10110 
10111       if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
10112         return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
10113 
10114       assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
10115              "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
10116       return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
10117     }
10118 
10119     if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10120       // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
10121       // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
10122       if (!Meth->isImplicit())
10123         return oc_method;
10124 
10125       if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
10126         return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
10127 
10128       if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
10129         return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
10130 
10131       assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
10132       return oc_method;
10133     }
10134 
10135     return oc_function;
10136   }();
10137 
10138   return std::make_pair(Kind, Select);
10139 }
10140 
10141 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) {
10142   // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload
10143   // set.
10144   if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl))
10145     S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(),
10146            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor)
10147       << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass();
10148 }
10149 
10150 } // end anonymous namespace
10151 
10152 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx,
10153                                     const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10154   for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) {
10155     bool AlwaysTrue;
10156     if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
10157         !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx))
10158       return false;
10159     if (!AlwaysTrue)
10160       return false;
10161   }
10162   return true;
10163 }
10164 
10165 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function.
10166 ///
10167 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic
10168 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are
10169 ///   we in overload resolution?
10170 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored
10171 ///   if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution.
10172 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD,
10173                                               bool Complain,
10174                                               bool InOverloadResolution,
10175                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
10176   if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) {
10177     if (Complain) {
10178       if (InOverloadResolution)
10179         S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10180                diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr);
10181       else
10182         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD;
10183     }
10184     return false;
10185   }
10186 
10187   if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
10188     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
10189     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc))
10190       return false;
10191     if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
10192       if (Complain) {
10193         if (InOverloadResolution)
10194           S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10195                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints);
10196         else
10197           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied)
10198               << FD;
10199         S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
10200       }
10201       return false;
10202     }
10203   }
10204 
10205   auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
10206     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
10207   });
10208   if (I == FD->param_end())
10209     return true;
10210 
10211   if (Complain) {
10212     // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing
10213     unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1;
10214     if (InOverloadResolution)
10215       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
10216              diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params)
10217           << ParamNo;
10218     else
10219       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params)
10220           << FD << ParamNo;
10221   }
10222   return false;
10223 }
10224 
10225 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S,
10226                                                const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10227   return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true,
10228                                            /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
10229                                            /*Loc=*/SourceLocation());
10230 }
10231 
10232 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function,
10233                                              bool Complain,
10234                                              SourceLocation Loc) {
10235   return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain,
10236                                              /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
10237                                              Loc);
10238 }
10239 
10240 // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling
10241 // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist.
10242 static bool shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
10243   const auto *ConvD = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn);
10244 
10245   if (!ConvD)
10246     return false;
10247   const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent());
10248   if (!RD->isLambda())
10249     return false;
10250 
10251   CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator();
10252   CallingConv CallOpCC =
10253       CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10254   QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType();
10255   CallingConv ConvToCC =
10256       ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10257 
10258   return ConvToCC != CallOpCC;
10259 }
10260 
10261 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
10262 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10263                                  OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind,
10264                                  QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) {
10265   if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn))
10266     return;
10267   if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
10268       !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion())
10269     return;
10270   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn))
10271     return;
10272 
10273   std::string FnDesc;
10274   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair =
10275       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc);
10276   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
10277                          << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second
10278                          << Fn << FnDesc;
10279 
10280   HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
10281   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
10282   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found);
10283 }
10284 
10285 static void
10286 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) {
10287   // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are
10288   // 'identical' but not equivalent:
10289   //
10290   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1
10291   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2
10292   //
10293   // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause
10294   // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent
10295   // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same
10296   // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try
10297   // to help the user figure out what happened.
10298 
10299   SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC;
10300   FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr;
10301   for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10302     if (!I->Function)
10303       continue;
10304     SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC;
10305     if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
10306       Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10307     else
10308       I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10309     if (AC.empty())
10310       continue;
10311     if (FirstCand == nullptr) {
10312       FirstCand = I->Function;
10313       FirstAC = AC;
10314     } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) {
10315       SecondCand = I->Function;
10316       SecondAC = AC;
10317     } else {
10318       // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is
10319       // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it.
10320       return;
10321     }
10322   }
10323   if (!SecondCand)
10324     return;
10325   // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on
10326   // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint).
10327   if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC,
10328                                                       SecondCand, SecondAC))
10329     // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out
10330     // from here.
10331     return;
10332 }
10333 
10334 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
10335 // OverloadedExpr
10336 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType,
10337                                      bool TakingAddress) {
10338   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10339 
10340   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
10341   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
10342 
10343   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
10344                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
10345        I != IEnd; ++I) {
10346     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
10347                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10348       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType,
10349                             TakingAddress);
10350     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
10351                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10352       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress);
10353     }
10354   }
10355 }
10356 
10357 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
10358 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
10359 /// target types of the conversion.
10360 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
10361                                  Sema &S,
10362                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
10363                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
10364   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
10365     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
10366   // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
10367   // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
10368   // refactoring here.
10369   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
10370   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
10371   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
10372   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10373     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
10374       break;
10375     ++CandsShown;
10376     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second);
10377   }
10378   if (I != E)
10379     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
10380 }
10381 
10382 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10383                                   unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10384   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
10385   assert(Conv.isBad());
10386   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
10387   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10388 
10389   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
10390   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
10391   // conversion-slot index.
10392   bool isObjectArgument = false;
10393   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10394     if (I == 0)
10395       isObjectArgument = true;
10396     else
10397       I--;
10398   }
10399 
10400   std::string FnDesc;
10401   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10402       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(),
10403                                 FnDesc);
10404 
10405   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
10406   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
10407   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
10408 
10409   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
10410     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
10411     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
10412     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
10413       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
10414     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
10415 
10416     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
10417         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10418         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy
10419         << Name << I + 1;
10420     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10421     return;
10422   }
10423 
10424   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
10425   // to a qualifier mismatch.
10426   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
10427   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
10428   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
10429     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
10430   else {
10431     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
10432     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10433       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10434         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType();
10435         CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
10436       }
10437   }
10438 
10439   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
10440       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
10441     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10442     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10443 
10444     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
10445       if (isObjectArgument)
10446         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this)
10447             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10448             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10449             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace();
10450       else
10451         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
10452             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10453             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10454             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
10455             << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1;
10456       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10457       return;
10458     }
10459 
10460     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10461       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
10462           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10463           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10464           << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
10465           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10466       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10467       return;
10468     }
10469 
10470     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
10471       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
10472           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10473           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10474           << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
10475           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10476       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10477       return;
10478     }
10479 
10480     if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) {
10481       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned)
10482           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10483           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10484           << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1;
10485       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10486       return;
10487     }
10488 
10489     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
10490     assert(CVR && "expected qualifiers mismatch");
10491 
10492     if (isObjectArgument) {
10493       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
10494           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10495           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10496           << (CVR - 1);
10497     } else {
10498       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
10499           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10500           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10501           << (CVR - 1) << I + 1;
10502     }
10503     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10504     return;
10505   }
10506 
10507   if (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue ||
10508       Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) {
10509     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_value_category)
10510         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10511         << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10512         << (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue)
10513         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
10514     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10515     return;
10516   }
10517 
10518   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
10519   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
10520   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
10521     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
10522         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10523         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10524         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10525     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10526     return;
10527   }
10528 
10529   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
10530   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
10531   // the failure.
10532   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
10533   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10534     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
10535   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
10536     // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10537     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
10538         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10539         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10540         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10541         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10542 
10543     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10544     return;
10545   }
10546 
10547   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
10548   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
10549   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10550     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10551       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10552                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10553           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10554           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10555           S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
10556                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
10557         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
10558     }
10559   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
10560                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
10561     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
10562                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
10563       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10564         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10565           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10566                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10567               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
10568             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
10569   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
10570     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
10571         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
10572         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10573         S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
10574       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
10575     }
10576   }
10577 
10578   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
10579     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
10580         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10581         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10582         << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1;
10583     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10584     return;
10585   }
10586 
10587   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
10588       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
10589       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10590       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10591       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10592         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
10593             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10594             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10595             << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10596         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10597         return;
10598       }
10599   }
10600 
10601   if (TakingCandidateAddress &&
10602       !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function))
10603     return;
10604 
10605   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10606   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
10607   FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10608         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10609         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10610         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10611 
10612   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
10613   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
10614        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
10615     FDiag << *HI;
10616   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
10617 
10618   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10619 }
10620 
10621 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
10622 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
10623 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
10624 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10625                                unsigned NumArgs) {
10626   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10627   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10628 
10629   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
10630   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
10631   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
10632   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
10633   // Just don't report anything.
10634   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
10635       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
10636     return true;
10637 
10638   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
10639     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
10640            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10641             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
10642   } else {
10643     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
10644            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10645             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
10646   }
10647 
10648   return false;
10649 }
10650 
10651 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
10652 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D,
10653                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10654   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
10655       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
10656       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
10657       " or too few arguments");
10658 
10659   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
10660 
10661   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
10662   const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10663   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10664 
10665   // at least / at most / exactly
10666   unsigned mode, modeCount;
10667   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
10668     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
10669         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
10670       mode = 0; // "at least"
10671     else
10672       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10673     modeCount = MinParams;
10674   } else {
10675     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
10676       mode = 1; // "at most"
10677     else
10678       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10679     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
10680   }
10681 
10682   std::string Description;
10683   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10684       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description);
10685 
10686   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
10687     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
10688         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10689         << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
10690   else
10691     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
10692         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10693         << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
10694 
10695   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10696 }
10697 
10698 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
10699 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10700                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10701   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
10702     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
10703 }
10704 
10705 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
10706   if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate())
10707     return TD;
10708   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
10709                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
10710 }
10711 
10712 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
10713 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated,
10714                                  DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
10715                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10716                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10717   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
10718   NamedDecl *ParamD;
10719   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
10720   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
10721   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
10722   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
10723   case Sema::TDK_Success:
10724     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
10725 
10726   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
10727     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10728     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10729            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
10730         << ParamD->getDeclName();
10731     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10732     return;
10733   }
10734 
10735   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: {
10736     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10737     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10738            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack)
10739         << ParamD->getDeclName()
10740         << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1)
10741         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10742     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10743     return;
10744   }
10745 
10746   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
10747     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
10748     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
10749 
10750     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
10751 
10752     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
10753     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
10754     QualifierCollector Qs;
10755     Qs.strip(Param);
10756     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
10757     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
10758 
10759     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
10760     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
10761     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
10762     // done on dependent types).
10763     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
10764 
10765     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
10766         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
10767     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10768     return;
10769   }
10770 
10771   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
10772     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
10773     int which = 0;
10774     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10775       which = 0;
10776     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) {
10777       // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two
10778       // different types for a non-type template parameter.
10779       // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this.
10780       QualType T1 =
10781           DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10782       QualType T2 =
10783           DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10784       if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) {
10785         S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10786                diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types)
10787           << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1
10788           << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2;
10789         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10790         return;
10791       }
10792 
10793       which = 1;
10794     } else {
10795       which = 2;
10796     }
10797 
10798     // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of
10799     // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that
10800     // includes additional useful information.
10801     if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10802         DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10803         DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() !=
10804             DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) {
10805       which = 3;
10806     }
10807 
10808     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10809            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
10810         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
10811         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10812     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10813     return;
10814   }
10815 
10816   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
10817     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
10818     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
10819       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10820              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
10821           << ParamD->getDeclName();
10822     else {
10823       int index = 0;
10824       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10825         index = TTP->getIndex();
10826       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
10827                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
10828         index = NTTP->getIndex();
10829       else
10830         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
10831       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10832              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
10833           << (index + 1);
10834     }
10835     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10836     return;
10837 
10838   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
10839     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10840     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10841     TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList();
10842     TemplateArgString = " ";
10843     TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10844         getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10845     if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10846       TemplateArgString.clear();
10847     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10848            diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints)
10849         << TemplateArgString;
10850 
10851     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(
10852         static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction);
10853     return;
10854   }
10855   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
10856   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
10857     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs);
10858     return;
10859 
10860   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
10861     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10862            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
10863     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10864     return;
10865 
10866   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
10867     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10868     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10869     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10870             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10871       TemplateArgString = " ";
10872       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10873           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10874       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10875         TemplateArgString.clear();
10876     }
10877 
10878     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
10879     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
10880     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10881           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
10882       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
10883       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
10884       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
10885         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
10886       return;
10887     }
10888 
10889     // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if.
10890     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10891         diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) {
10892       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10893              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement)
10894         << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString;
10895       return;
10896     }
10897 
10898     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
10899     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
10900     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
10901     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
10902     SourceRange R;
10903     if (PDiag) {
10904       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
10905       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
10906       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
10907     }
10908 
10909     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10910            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
10911         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
10912     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10913     return;
10914   }
10915 
10916   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
10917   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
10918     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10919     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10920     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10921             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10922       TemplateArgString = " ";
10923       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10924           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10925       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10926         TemplateArgString.clear();
10927     }
10928 
10929     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch)
10930         << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1)
10931         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()
10932         << TemplateArgString
10933         << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested);
10934     break;
10935   }
10936 
10937   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
10938     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
10939     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10940     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10941     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
10942         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
10943       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
10944       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
10945       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
10946           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
10947         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
10948             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
10949           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
10950           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
10951           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
10952           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
10953           //    name for types, not decls.
10954           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
10955           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10956                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
10957               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
10958           return;
10959         }
10960       }
10961     }
10962 
10963     if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) &&
10964         !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated)))
10965       return;
10966 
10967     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
10968     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
10969     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
10970     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
10971     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10972            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
10973         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
10974     return;
10975   }
10976   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
10977   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
10978   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
10979     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
10980     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10981     return;
10982   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
10983     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10984            diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch);
10985     return;
10986   }
10987 }
10988 
10989 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
10990 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10991                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10992                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10993   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
10994   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
10995     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
10996       return;
10997   }
10998   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern
10999                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress);
11000 }
11001 
11002 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
11003 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11004   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
11005   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11006 
11007   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
11008                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
11009 
11010   std::string FnDesc;
11011   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11012       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee,
11013                                 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11014 
11015   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
11016       << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11017       << FnDesc /* Ignored */
11018       << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
11019 
11020   // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the
11021   // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case.
11022   CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee);
11023   if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) {
11024     CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent();
11025     Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM;
11026 
11027     switch (FnKindPair.first) {
11028     default:
11029       return;
11030     case oc_implicit_default_constructor:
11031       CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor;
11032       break;
11033     case oc_implicit_copy_constructor:
11034       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor;
11035       break;
11036     case oc_implicit_move_constructor:
11037       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor;
11038       break;
11039     case oc_implicit_copy_assignment:
11040       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment;
11041       break;
11042     case oc_implicit_move_assignment:
11043       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment;
11044       break;
11045     };
11046 
11047     bool ConstRHS = false;
11048     if (Meth->getNumParams()) {
11049       if (const ReferenceType *RT =
11050               Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
11051         ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified();
11052       }
11053     }
11054 
11055     S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth,
11056                                               /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS,
11057                                               /* Diagnose */ true);
11058   }
11059 }
11060 
11061 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11062   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11063   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
11064 
11065   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11066          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
11067       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
11068 }
11069 
11070 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11071   ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function);
11072   assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate");
11073 
11074   unsigned Kind;
11075   switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) {
11076   case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor:
11077     Kind = 0;
11078     break;
11079   case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion:
11080     Kind = 1;
11081     break;
11082   case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide:
11083     Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2;
11084     break;
11085   default:
11086     llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl");
11087   }
11088 
11089   // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration
11090   // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the
11091   // 'explicit' specifier.
11092   // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes.
11093   FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl();
11094   if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern())
11095     First = Pattern->getFirstDecl();
11096 
11097   S.Diag(First->getLocation(),
11098          diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit)
11099       << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0)
11100       << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
11101 }
11102 
11103 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11104   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11105 
11106   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11107          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension)
11108     << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee);
11109 }
11110 
11111 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
11112 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
11113 ///
11114 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
11115 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
11116 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
11117 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
11118 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
11119 /// overload.
11120 ///
11121 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
11122 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
11123 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
11124 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor
11125 /// candidates only).
11126 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11127                                   unsigned NumArgs,
11128                                   bool TakingCandidateAddress,
11129                                   LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) {
11130   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
11131   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn))
11132     return;
11133 
11134   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
11135   if (Cand->Viable) {
11136     if (Fn->isDeleted()) {
11137       std::string FnDesc;
11138       std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11139           ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11140                                     Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11141 
11142       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
11143           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
11144           << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
11145       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11146       return;
11147     }
11148 
11149     // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
11150     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11151     return;
11152   }
11153 
11154   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
11155   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
11156   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
11157     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
11158 
11159   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
11160     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs,
11161                                 TakingCandidateAddress);
11162 
11163   case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: {
11164     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor)
11165       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0);
11166     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11167     return;
11168   }
11169 
11170   case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: {
11171     Qualifiers QualsForPrinting;
11172     QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS);
11173     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11174            diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch)
11175         << QualsForPrinting;
11176     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11177     return;
11178   }
11179 
11180   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
11181   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
11182   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
11183     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11184 
11185   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
11186     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
11187     for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
11188       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
11189         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress);
11190 
11191     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
11192     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
11193     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
11194     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11195   }
11196 
11197   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
11198     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
11199 
11200   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
11201     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
11202 
11203   case ovl_fail_explicit:
11204     return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand);
11205 
11206   case ovl_fail_ext_disabled:
11207     return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand);
11208 
11209   case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice:
11210     // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here.
11211     if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor())
11212       return;
11213     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11214            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice)
11215       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0)
11216       << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType();
11217     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11218     return;
11219 
11220   case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: {
11221     bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function);
11222     (void)Available;
11223     assert(!Available);
11224     break;
11225   }
11226   case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function:
11227     // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored.
11228     break;
11229 
11230   case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: {
11231     std::string FnDesc;
11232     std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11233         ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11234                                   Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11235 
11236     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11237            diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied)
11238         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11239         << FnDesc /* Ignored */;
11240     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
11241     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction))
11242       break;
11243     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
11244   }
11245   }
11246 }
11247 
11248 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11249   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Cand->Surrogate))
11250     return;
11251 
11252   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
11253   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
11254   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
11255   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
11256   bool isLValueReference = false;
11257   bool isRValueReference = false;
11258   bool isPointer = false;
11259   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11260         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
11261     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11262     isLValueReference = true;
11263   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11264                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
11265     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11266     isRValueReference = true;
11267   }
11268   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
11269     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11270     isPointer = true;
11271   }
11272   // Desugar down to a function type.
11273   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
11274   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
11275   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
11276   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
11277   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
11278 
11279   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
11280     << FnType;
11281 }
11282 
11283 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc,
11284                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
11285                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11286   assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
11287   std::string TypeStr("operator");
11288   TypeStr += Opc;
11289   TypeStr += "(";
11290   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString();
11291   if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
11292     TypeStr += ")";
11293     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11294   } else {
11295     TypeStr += ", ";
11296     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString();
11297     TypeStr += ")";
11298     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11299   }
11300 }
11301 
11302 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11303                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11304   for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) {
11305     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
11306     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
11307 
11308     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
11309         S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
11310   }
11311 }
11312 
11313 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11314   if (Cand->Function)
11315     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
11316   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11317     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
11318   return SourceLocation();
11319 }
11320 
11321 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
11322   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
11323   case Sema::TDK_Success:
11324   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
11325     llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction");
11326 
11327   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
11328   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
11329   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
11330     return 1;
11331 
11332   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
11333   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
11334     return 2;
11335 
11336   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
11337   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
11338   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
11339   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
11340   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
11341   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
11342   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
11343     return 3;
11344 
11345   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
11346     return 4;
11347 
11348   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
11349     return 5;
11350 
11351   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
11352   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
11353     return 6;
11354   }
11355   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
11356 }
11357 
11358 namespace {
11359 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
11360   Sema &S;
11361   SourceLocation Loc;
11362   size_t NumArgs;
11363   OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK;
11364 
11365   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(
11366       Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs,
11367       OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK)
11368       : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {}
11369 
11370   OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const {
11371     // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we
11372     // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else.
11373     if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11374         C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11375       return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11376 
11377     if (C->Function) {
11378       if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic())
11379         return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11380       if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments())
11381         return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
11382     }
11383 
11384     return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11385   }
11386 
11387   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
11388                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
11389     // Fast-path this check.
11390     if (L == R) return false;
11391 
11392     // Order first by viability.
11393     if (L->Viable) {
11394       if (!R->Viable) return true;
11395 
11396       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
11397       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
11398       // that could exploit it.
11399       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11400         return true;
11401       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11402         return false;
11403     } else if (R->Viable)
11404       return false;
11405 
11406     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
11407 
11408     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
11409     if (!L->Viable) {
11410       OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L);
11411       OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R);
11412 
11413       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
11414       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11415           LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11416         if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11417             RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11418           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11419           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11420           if (LDist == RDist) {
11421             if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind)
11422               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
11423               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
11424             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
11425             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
11426             // than there were arguments given.
11427             return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11428           }
11429           return LDist < RDist;
11430         }
11431         return false;
11432       }
11433       if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11434           RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11435         return true;
11436 
11437       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
11438       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
11439       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
11440         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11441           return true;
11442 
11443         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
11444         // comes first.
11445         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11446         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11447         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
11448         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
11449         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
11450           return numLFixes < numRFixes;
11451         }
11452 
11453         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
11454         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
11455         assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
11456 
11457         int leftBetter = 0;
11458         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
11459         for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
11460           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
11461                                                      L->Conversions[I],
11462                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
11463           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
11464             leftBetter++;
11465             break;
11466 
11467           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
11468             leftBetter--;
11469             break;
11470 
11471           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
11472             break;
11473           }
11474         }
11475         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
11476         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
11477 
11478       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11479         return false;
11480 
11481       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
11482         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11483           return true;
11484 
11485         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11486           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
11487                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11488       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11489         return false;
11490 
11491       // TODO: others?
11492     }
11493 
11494     // Sort everything else by location.
11495     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11496     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11497 
11498     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11499     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
11500     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
11501 
11502     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11503   }
11504 };
11505 }
11506 
11507 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
11508 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if
11509 /// possible.
11510 static void
11511 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11512                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11513                            OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) {
11514   assert(!Cand->Viable);
11515 
11516   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
11517   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11518     return;
11519 
11520   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
11521   bool Unfixable = false;
11522   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
11523   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
11524 
11525   // Attempt to fix the bad conversion.
11526   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
11527   for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/;
11528        ++ConvIdx) {
11529     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
11530     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
11531         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
11532       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11533       break;
11534     }
11535   }
11536 
11537   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
11538   // operation somehow.
11539   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
11540 
11541   unsigned ConvIdx = 0;
11542   unsigned ArgIdx = 0;
11543   ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes;
11544   bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed();
11545 
11546   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11547     QualType ConvType
11548       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11549     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11550       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
11551     ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11552     // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11553     ConvIdx = 1;
11554   } else if (Cand->Function) {
11555     ParamTypes =
11556         Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11557     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
11558         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) {
11559       // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11560       ConvIdx = 1;
11561       if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
11562           Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call)
11563         // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11564         ArgIdx = 1;
11565     }
11566   } else {
11567     // Builtin operator.
11568     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
11569     ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes;
11570   }
11571 
11572   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
11573   for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0;
11574        ConvIdx != ConvCount;
11575        ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) {
11576     assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion");
11577     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
11578       // We've already checked this conversion.
11579     } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) {
11580       if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType())
11581         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion(
11582             Args[ArgIdx]->getType());
11583       else {
11584         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] =
11585             TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx],
11586                                   SuppressUserConversions,
11587                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
11588                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
11589                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
11590         // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
11591         if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
11592           Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11593       }
11594     } else
11595       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
11596   }
11597 }
11598 
11599 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates(
11600     Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11601     SourceLocation OpLoc,
11602     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11603   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
11604   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
11605   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
11606   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
11607   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11608     if (!Filter(*Cand))
11609       continue;
11610     switch (OCD) {
11611     case OCD_AllCandidates:
11612       if (!Cand->Viable) {
11613         if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11614           // This a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
11615           // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11616           continue;
11617         }
11618         CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind);
11619       }
11620       break;
11621 
11622     case OCD_ViableCandidates:
11623       if (!Cand->Viable)
11624         continue;
11625       break;
11626 
11627     case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates:
11628       if (!Cand->Best)
11629         continue;
11630       break;
11631     }
11632 
11633     Cands.push_back(Cand);
11634   }
11635 
11636   llvm::stable_sort(
11637       Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind));
11638 
11639   return Cands;
11640 }
11641 
11642 bool OverloadCandidateSet::shouldDeferDiags(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11643                                             SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11644   bool DeferHint = false;
11645   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) {
11646     // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates or
11647     // host device candidates.
11648     auto WrongSidedCands =
11649         CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) {
11650           return (Cand.Viable == false &&
11651                   Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target) ||
11652                  (Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>() &&
11653                   Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>());
11654         });
11655     DeferHint = WrongSidedCands.size();
11656   }
11657   return DeferHint;
11658 }
11659 
11660 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the
11661 /// candidates in the candidate set.
11662 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(
11663     PartialDiagnosticAt PD, Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
11664     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11665     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11666 
11667   auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter);
11668 
11669   S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc));
11670 
11671   NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc);
11672 
11673   if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates)
11674     MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()});
11675 }
11676 
11677 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11678                                           ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands,
11679                                           StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11680   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
11681 
11682   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11683   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11684   auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end();
11685   for (; I != E; ++I) {
11686     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
11687 
11688     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
11689     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11690     // candidate list.
11691     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
11692       break;
11693     }
11694     ++CandsShown;
11695 
11696     if (Cand->Function)
11697       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(),
11698                             /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS);
11699     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11700       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
11701     else {
11702       assert(Cand->Viable &&
11703              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11704       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
11705       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
11706       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
11707       //
11708       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
11709       // different ambiguities, though.
11710       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
11711         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
11712         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
11713       }
11714 
11715       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
11716       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
11717     }
11718   }
11719 
11720   if (I != E)
11721     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates,
11722            shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc))
11723         << int(E - I);
11724 }
11725 
11726 static SourceLocation
11727 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
11728   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
11729                               : SourceLocation();
11730 }
11731 
11732 namespace {
11733 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
11734   Sema &S;
11735   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
11736 
11737   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
11738                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
11739     // Fast-path this check.
11740     if (L == R)
11741       return false;
11742 
11743     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
11744 
11745     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
11746     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11747       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
11748              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11749 
11750     // Sort everything else by location.
11751     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11752     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11753 
11754     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11755     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
11756       return false;
11757     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
11758       return true;
11759 
11760     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11761   }
11762 };
11763 }
11764 
11765 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
11766 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
11767 /// deductions.
11768 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S,
11769                                                  bool ForTakingAddress) {
11770   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern
11771                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress);
11772 }
11773 
11774 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
11775   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
11776     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
11777   }
11778 }
11779 
11780 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
11781   destroyCandidates();
11782   Candidates.clear();
11783 }
11784 
11785 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
11786 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
11787 /// the candidate set.
11788 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
11789 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
11790 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
11791   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
11792   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
11793   // and sort those.
11794   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
11795   Cands.reserve(size());
11796   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11797     if (Cand->Specialization)
11798       Cands.push_back(Cand);
11799     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
11800     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11801   }
11802 
11803   llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
11804 
11805   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
11806   // for generalization purposes (?).
11807   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11808 
11809   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
11810   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11811   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
11812     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
11813 
11814     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
11815     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11816     // candidate list.
11817     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
11818       break;
11819     ++CandsShown;
11820 
11821     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
11822            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11823     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress);
11824   }
11825 
11826   if (I != E)
11827     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
11828 }
11829 
11830 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
11831 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
11832 // R (A) --> R(A)
11833 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
11834 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
11835 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
11836 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
11837   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
11838   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
11839     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
11840     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11841   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
11842     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11843     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11844   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
11845     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11846     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11847   Ret =
11848     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
11849   return Ret;
11850 }
11851 
11852 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc,
11853                                  bool Complain = true) {
11854   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
11855       S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain))
11856     return true;
11857 
11858   auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11859   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
11860       isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) &&
11861       !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT))
11862     return true;
11863 
11864   return false;
11865 }
11866 
11867 namespace {
11868 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
11869 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
11870 class AddressOfFunctionResolver {
11871   Sema& S;
11872   Expr* SourceExpr;
11873   const QualType& TargetType;
11874   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
11875 
11876   bool Complain;
11877   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
11878   ASTContext& Context;
11879 
11880   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
11881   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
11882   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
11883   bool HasComplained;
11884 
11885   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
11886   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
11887   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
11888   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
11889   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
11890 
11891 public:
11892   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
11893                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
11894       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
11895         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
11896         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
11897             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
11898         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
11899         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
11900         HasComplained(false),
11901         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
11902         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
11903         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) {
11904     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
11905 
11906     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
11907       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
11908         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
11909             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
11910           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
11911     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11912       DeclAccessPair dap;
11913       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
11914               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
11915         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
11916           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11917             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
11918             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
11919             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
11920             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
11921 
11922             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
11923             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
11924             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
11925               return;
11926           }
11927 
11928         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
11929       }
11930       return;
11931     }
11932 
11933     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
11934       OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
11935 
11936     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
11937       // C++ [over.over]p4:
11938       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
11939       if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) {
11940         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
11941           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
11942         else
11943           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
11944       }
11945     }
11946 
11947     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1)
11948       EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches();
11949   }
11950 
11951   bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; }
11952 
11953 private:
11954   bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
11955     QualType Discard;
11956     return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) ||
11957            S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard);
11958   }
11959 
11960   /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the
11961   /// desired type than B.
11962   bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) {
11963     // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it
11964     // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to
11965     // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match.
11966     return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) &&
11967            (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) ||
11968             compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better);
11969   }
11970 
11971   /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate,
11972   /// false otherwise.
11973   bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() {
11974     // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best",
11975     // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best.
11976     auto Best = Matches.begin();
11977     for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I)
11978       if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second))
11979         Best = I;
11980 
11981     const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second;
11982     auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn](
11983         const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) {
11984       return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second);
11985     };
11986 
11987     // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best
11988     // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error
11989     if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest))
11990       return false;
11991     Matches[0] = *Best;
11992     Matches.resize(1);
11993     return true;
11994   }
11995 
11996   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
11997     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
11998   }
11999 
12000   // [ToType]     [Return]
12001 
12002   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
12003   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
12004   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
12005   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
12006     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
12007   }
12008 
12009   // return true if any matching specializations were found
12010   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
12011                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12012     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
12013               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
12014       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
12015       // static when converting to member pointer.
12016       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12017         return false;
12018     }
12019     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12020       return false;
12021 
12022     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12023     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12024     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12025     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12026     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12027     //   overloaded functions considered.
12028     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12029     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12030     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
12031           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
12032                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
12033                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
12034                                       Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12035       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12036       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12037           .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12038                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12039       return false;
12040     }
12041 
12042     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
12043     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
12044     // This function template specicalization works.
12045     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
12046               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
12047               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
12048 
12049     if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization))
12050       return false;
12051 
12052     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
12053     return true;
12054   }
12055 
12056   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
12057                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12058     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12059       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
12060       // when converting to member pointer.
12061       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12062         return false;
12063     }
12064     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12065       return false;
12066 
12067     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
12068       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
12069         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
12070           if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl))
12071             return false;
12072       if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) {
12073         const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
12074         if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
12075           return false;
12076       }
12077 
12078       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
12079       // now.
12080       if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12081                                Complain)) {
12082         HasComplained |= Complain;
12083         return false;
12084       }
12085 
12086       if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl))
12087         return false;
12088 
12089       // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical.
12090       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
12091           candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) {
12092         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(
12093             CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
12094         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
12095         return true;
12096       }
12097     }
12098 
12099     return false;
12100   }
12101 
12102   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
12103     bool Ret = false;
12104 
12105     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
12106     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
12107     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12108       return false;
12109 
12110     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12111                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12112          I != E; ++I) {
12113       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
12114       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
12115 
12116       // C++ [over.over]p3:
12117       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
12118       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
12119       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
12120       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
12121       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
12122       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12123                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
12124         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
12125           Ret = true;
12126       }
12127       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
12128       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
12129                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
12130         Ret = true;
12131     }
12132     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
12133     return Ret;
12134   }
12135 
12136   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
12137     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
12138     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
12139     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
12140     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
12141     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
12142 
12143     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
12144     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
12145     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
12146     // best function template (if it exists).
12147 
12148     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
12149     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
12150       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
12151 
12152     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
12153     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
12154     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
12155         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
12156         SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(),
12157         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12158             << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
12159         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
12160             << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template,
12161         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
12162 
12163     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
12164       // Make it the first and only element
12165       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
12166       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
12167       Matches.resize(1);
12168     } else
12169       HasComplained |= Complain;
12170   }
12171 
12172   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
12173     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
12174     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
12175     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
12176       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
12177         ++I;
12178       else {
12179         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
12180         Matches.resize(N);
12181       }
12182     }
12183   }
12184 
12185   void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() {
12186     S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches);
12187   }
12188 
12189 public:
12190   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
12191     assert(Matches.empty());
12192     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
12193         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
12194         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12195     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
12196       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12197                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12198     else {
12199       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
12200       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
12201       // normally.
12202       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12203                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12204            I != IEnd; ++I)
12205         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
12206                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
12207           if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun))
12208             S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType,
12209                                     /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12210       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc());
12211     }
12212   }
12213 
12214   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12215     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
12216       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
12217   }
12218 
12219   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12220       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
12221       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
12222       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
12223       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
12224         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12225   }
12226 
12227   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12228     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
12229   }
12230 
12231   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12232     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12233            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
12234         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12235   }
12236 
12237   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
12238     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
12239         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
12240   }
12241 
12242   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
12243     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
12244     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12245         << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12246     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12247                                 /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12248   }
12249 
12250   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
12251 
12252   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
12253 
12254   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
12255     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12256     return Matches[0].second;
12257   }
12258 
12259   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
12260     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12261     return &Matches[0].first;
12262   }
12263 };
12264 }
12265 
12266 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
12267 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
12268 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
12269 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
12270 ///
12271 /// @code
12272 /// int f(double);
12273 /// int f(int);
12274 ///
12275 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
12276 /// @endcode
12277 ///
12278 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
12279 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
12280 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
12281 FunctionDecl *
12282 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
12283                                          QualType TargetType,
12284                                          bool Complain,
12285                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
12286                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
12287   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12288 
12289   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
12290                                      Complain);
12291   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
12292   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
12293   bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained();
12294   if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) {
12295     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12296       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
12297     else
12298       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
12299   }
12300   else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain)
12301     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
12302   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
12303     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
12304     assert(Fn);
12305     if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
12306       ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT);
12307     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
12308     if (Complain) {
12309       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
12310         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
12311       else
12312         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
12313     }
12314   }
12315 
12316   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
12317     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
12318   return Fn;
12319 }
12320 
12321 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12322 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken.
12323 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null.
12324 ///
12325 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload
12326 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate
12327 /// that is more constrained than the rest.
12328 FunctionDecl *
12329 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) {
12330   OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E);
12331   OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression;
12332   bool IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12333   FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr;
12334   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12335   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls;
12336 
12337   auto CheckMoreConstrained =
12338       [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> {
12339         SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2;
12340         FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1);
12341         FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2);
12342         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
12343         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1))
12344           return None;
12345         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
12346           return None;
12347         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2)
12348           return None;
12349         return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
12350       };
12351 
12352   // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for
12353   // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks
12354   // enable_if/pass_object_size/...
12355   for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12356     auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl());
12357     if (!FD)
12358       return nullptr;
12359 
12360     if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
12361       continue;
12362 
12363     // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the
12364     // previous one.
12365     if (Result) {
12366       Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD,
12367                                                                         Result);
12368       if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) {
12369         IsResultAmbiguous = true;
12370         AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD);
12371         continue;
12372       }
12373       if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious)
12374         continue;
12375       // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it.
12376     }
12377     IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12378     DAP = I.getPair();
12379     Result = FD;
12380   }
12381 
12382   if (IsResultAmbiguous)
12383     return nullptr;
12384 
12385   if (Result) {
12386     SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC;
12387     // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with
12388     // the selected result.
12389     for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls)
12390       if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue())
12391         return nullptr;
12392     Pair = DAP;
12393   }
12394   return Result;
12395 }
12396 
12397 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded
12398 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This
12399 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if
12400 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay.
12401 ///
12402 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails.
12403 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true.
12404 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(
12405     ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) {
12406   Expr *E = SrcExpr.get();
12407   assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload");
12408 
12409   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12410   FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP);
12411   if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
12412       Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion())
12413     return false;
12414 
12415   // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and
12416   // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check
12417   // for both.
12418   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc());
12419   CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP);
12420   Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found);
12421   if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType())
12422     SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false);
12423   else
12424     SrcExpr = Fixed;
12425   return true;
12426 }
12427 
12428 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12429 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
12430 ///
12431 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
12432 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
12433 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
12434 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
12435 ///
12436 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
12437 /// returned.
12438 FunctionDecl *
12439 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
12440                                                   bool Complain,
12441                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
12442   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12443   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
12444   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
12445   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12446   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
12447   //   operator.
12448 
12449   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
12450   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
12451     return nullptr;
12452 
12453   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
12454   ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12455   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
12456 
12457   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
12458   // whose type matches exactly.
12459   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
12460   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
12461          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12462     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
12463     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
12464     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
12465     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
12466     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
12467     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
12468     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12469       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
12470 
12471     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12472     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12473     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12474     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12475     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12476     //   overloaded functions considered.
12477     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12478     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12479     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
12480           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12481                                     Specialization, Info,
12482                                     /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12483       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12484       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
12485       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12486           .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12487                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12488       continue;
12489     }
12490 
12491     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
12492 
12493     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
12494     if (Matched) {
12495       if (Complain) {
12496         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12497           << ovl->getName();
12498         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
12499       }
12500       return nullptr;
12501     }
12502 
12503     Matched = Specialization;
12504     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
12505   }
12506 
12507   if (Matched &&
12508       completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
12509     return nullptr;
12510 
12511   return Matched;
12512 }
12513 
12514 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
12515 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
12516 //
12517 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
12518 //
12519 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
12520 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
12521 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
12522 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12523                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
12524                       bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining,
12525                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
12526                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
12527   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12528 
12529   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
12530 
12531   DeclAccessPair found;
12532   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
12533   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12534                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
12535     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) {
12536       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12537       return true;
12538     }
12539 
12540     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
12541     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
12542     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
12543     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
12544     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
12545         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
12546         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
12547       if (!complain) return false;
12548 
12549       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
12550            diag::err_bound_member_function)
12551         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
12552 
12553       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
12554       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
12555       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
12556       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
12557       // the static candidates were rejected.
12558       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12559       return true;
12560     }
12561 
12562     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
12563     SingleFunctionExpression =
12564         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
12565 
12566     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
12567     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
12568       SingleFunctionExpression =
12569         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
12570       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
12571         SrcExpr = ExprError();
12572         return true;
12573       }
12574     }
12575   }
12576 
12577   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
12578     if (complain) {
12579       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
12580         << ovl.Expression->getName()
12581         << DestTypeForComplaining
12582         << OpRangeForComplaining
12583         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
12584       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
12585 
12586       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12587       return true;
12588     }
12589 
12590     return false;
12591   }
12592 
12593   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
12594   return true;
12595 }
12596 
12597 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set.
12598 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
12599                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
12600                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12601                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12602                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12603                                        bool PartialOverloading,
12604                                        bool KnownValid) {
12605   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
12606   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
12607     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
12608 
12609   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
12610     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
12611       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
12612       return;
12613     }
12614     // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates.
12615     if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()))
12616       return;
12617 
12618     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
12619                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12620                            PartialOverloading);
12621     return;
12622   }
12623 
12624   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
12625       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
12626     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
12627                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
12628                                    /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12629                                    PartialOverloading);
12630     return;
12631   }
12632 
12633   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
12634 }
12635 
12636 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
12637 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
12638 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12639                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12640                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12641                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
12642 
12643 #ifndef NDEBUG
12644   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
12645   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
12646   //
12647   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
12648   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
12649   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
12650   //
12651   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
12652   //
12653   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
12654   //        using-declaration, or
12655   //
12656   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
12657   //        template
12658   //
12659   //   then Y is empty.
12660 
12661   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12662     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12663            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12664       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
12665       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
12666              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
12667       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
12668     }
12669   }
12670 #endif
12671 
12672   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
12673   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12674   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12675   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12676     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12677     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12678   }
12679 
12680   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12681          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
12682     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12683                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
12684                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
12685 
12686   if (ULE->requiresADL())
12687     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
12688                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12689                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
12690 }
12691 
12692 /// Add the call candidates from the given set of lookup results to the given
12693 /// overload set. Non-function lookup results are ignored.
12694 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(
12695     LookupResult &R, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12696     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
12697   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
12698     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12699                                CandidateSet, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
12700 }
12701 
12702 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
12703 /// a different namespace.
12704 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
12705   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
12706   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
12707   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
12708     return false;
12709 
12710   default:
12711     return true;
12712   }
12713 }
12714 
12715 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
12716 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
12717 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
12718 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
12719 ///
12720 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12721 static bool DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(
12722     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
12723     LookupResult &R, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
12724     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12725     CXXRecordDecl **FoundInClass = nullptr) {
12726   if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty())
12727     return false;
12728 
12729   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
12730     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
12731       continue;
12732 
12733     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
12734 
12735     if (!R.empty()) {
12736       R.suppressDiagnostics();
12737 
12738       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
12739       SemaRef.AddOverloadedCallCandidates(R, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12740                                           Candidates);
12741 
12742       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12743       OverloadingResult OR =
12744           Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best);
12745 
12746       if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
12747         // We either found non-function declarations or a best viable function
12748         // at class scope. A class-scope lookup result disables ADL. Don't
12749         // look past this, but let the caller know that we found something that
12750         // either is, or might be, usable in this class.
12751         if (FoundInClass) {
12752           *FoundInClass = RD;
12753           if (OR == OR_Success) {
12754             R.clear();
12755             R.addDecl(Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
12756             R.resolveKind();
12757           }
12758         }
12759         return false;
12760       }
12761 
12762       if (OR != OR_Success) {
12763         // There wasn't a unique best function or function template.
12764         return false;
12765       }
12766 
12767       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
12768       // declaring the function there instead.
12769       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
12770       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
12771       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
12772                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
12773                                                  AssociatedClasses);
12774       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
12775       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
12776         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
12777         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
12778                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
12779                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
12780           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
12781           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
12782             continue;
12783 
12784           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
12785           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
12786           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
12787           if (NS &&
12788               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
12789             continue;
12790 
12791           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
12792         }
12793       }
12794 
12795       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12796         << R.getLookupName();
12797       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
12798         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12799                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12800           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
12801       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
12802         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12803                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12804           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
12805       } else {
12806         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
12807         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
12808         // a localized representation of a list of items.
12809         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12810                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12811           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
12812       }
12813 
12814       // Try to recover by calling this function.
12815       return true;
12816     }
12817 
12818     R.clear();
12819   }
12820 
12821   return false;
12822 }
12823 
12824 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
12825 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
12826 /// was defined.
12827 ///
12828 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12829 static bool
12830 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
12831                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
12832                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
12833   DeclarationName OpName =
12834     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
12835   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
12836   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
12837                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
12838                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
12839 }
12840 
12841 namespace {
12842 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
12843   Sema &SemaRef;
12844 public:
12845   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
12846     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
12847     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
12848   }
12849 
12850   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
12851     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
12852   }
12853 };
12854 
12855 }
12856 
12857 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
12858 ///
12859 /// This function will do one of three things:
12860 ///  * Diagnose, recover, and return a recovery expression.
12861 ///  * Diagnose, fail to recover, and return ExprError().
12862 ///  * Do not diagnose, do not recover, and return ExprResult(). The caller is
12863 ///    expected to diagnose as appropriate.
12864 static ExprResult
12865 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12866                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12867                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12868                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12869                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12870                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
12871   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
12872   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
12873   //
12874   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
12875   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
12876   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
12877     return ExprResult();
12878   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
12879 
12880   CXXScopeSpec SS;
12881   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
12882   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
12883 
12884   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12885   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12886   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12887     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12888     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12889   }
12890 
12891   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
12892                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
12893   CXXRecordDecl *FoundInClass = nullptr;
12894   if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
12895                              OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
12896                              ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &FoundInClass)) {
12897     // OK, diagnosed a two-phase lookup issue.
12898   } else if (EmptyLookup) {
12899     // Try to recover from an empty lookup with typo correction.
12900     R.clear();
12901     NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{};
12902     FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
12903                                                 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
12904                                                 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
12905     CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator =
12906         AllowTypoCorrection
12907             ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator)
12908             : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator);
12909     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12910                                     Args))
12911       return ExprError();
12912   } else if (FoundInClass && SemaRef.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
12913     // We found a usable declaration of the name in a dependent base of some
12914     // enclosing class.
12915     // FIXME: We should also explain why the candidates found by name lookup
12916     // were not viable.
12917     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(R))
12918       return ExprError();
12919   } else {
12920     // We had viable candidates and couldn't recover; let the caller diagnose
12921     // this.
12922     return ExprResult();
12923   }
12924 
12925   // If we get here, we should have issued a diagnostic and formed a recovery
12926   // lookup result.
12927   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
12928 
12929   // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out.
12930   if (R.isAmbiguous()) {
12931     R.suppressDiagnostics();
12932     return ExprError();
12933   }
12934 
12935   // Build an implicit member access expression if appropriate. Just drop the
12936   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
12937   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
12938   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
12939     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R,
12940                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs, S);
12941   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
12942     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
12943                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12944   else
12945     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
12946 
12947   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
12948     return ExprError();
12949 
12950   auto CallE =
12951       SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
12952                             MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), RParenLoc);
12953   if (CallE.isInvalid())
12954     return ExprError();
12955   // We now have recovered a callee. However, building a real call may lead to
12956   // incorrect secondary diagnostics if our recovery wasn't correct.
12957   // We keep the recovery behavior but suppress all following diagnostics by
12958   // using RecoveryExpr. We deliberately drop the return type of the recovery
12959   // function, and rely on clang's dependent mechanism to suppress following
12960   // diagnostics.
12961   return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(CallE.get()->getBeginLoc(),
12962                                     CallE.get()->getEndLoc(), {CallE.get()});
12963 }
12964 
12965 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
12966 /// the given function.
12967 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
12968 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12969                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12970                                   MultiExprArg Args,
12971                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12972                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12973                                   ExprResult *Result) {
12974 #ifndef NDEBUG
12975   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12976     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
12977     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
12978 
12979     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
12980     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
12981     FunctionDecl *F;
12982     if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() &&
12983         ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
12984         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
12985         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
12986       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
12987 
12988     // We don't perform ADL in C.
12989     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
12990   }
12991 #endif
12992 
12993   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12994   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
12995     *Result = ExprError();
12996     return true;
12997   }
12998 
12999   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
13000   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
13001   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
13002 
13003   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
13004       CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() &&
13005       (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
13006 
13007     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13008     if (CandidateSet->empty() ||
13009         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) ==
13010             OR_No_Viable_Function) {
13011       // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function
13012       // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name
13013       // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent
13014       // base classes.
13015       CallExpr *CE =
13016           CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
13017                            RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13018       CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup();
13019       *Result = CE;
13020       return true;
13021     }
13022   }
13023 
13024   if (CandidateSet->empty())
13025     return false;
13026 
13027   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
13028   return false;
13029 }
13030 
13031 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be.
13032 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS,
13033                                    OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) {
13034   llvm::Optional<QualType> Result;
13035   // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate.
13036   auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) {
13037     if (!Candidate.Function)
13038       return;
13039     if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl())
13040       return;
13041     QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType();
13042     if (T.isNull())
13043       return;
13044     if (!Result)
13045       Result = T;
13046     else if (Result != T)
13047       Result = QualType();
13048   };
13049 
13050   // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset.
13051   // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int.
13052   //
13053   // First, consider only the best candidate.
13054   if (Best && *Best != CS.end())
13055     ConsiderCandidate(**Best);
13056   // Next, consider only viable candidates.
13057   if (!Result)
13058     for (const auto &C : CS)
13059       if (C.Viable)
13060         ConsiderCandidate(C);
13061   // Finally, consider all candidates.
13062   if (!Result)
13063     for (const auto &C : CS)
13064       ConsiderCandidate(C);
13065 
13066   if (!Result)
13067     return QualType();
13068   auto Value = Result.getValue();
13069   if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType())
13070     return QualType();
13071   return Value;
13072 }
13073 
13074 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
13075 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
13076 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
13077 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13078                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13079                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13080                                            MultiExprArg Args,
13081                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13082                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
13083                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
13084                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
13085                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
13086                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
13087   switch (OverloadResult) {
13088   case OR_Success: {
13089     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13090     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
13091     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
13092       return ExprError();
13093     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13094     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13095                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13096                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13097   }
13098 
13099   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13100     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
13101     // have meant to call.
13102     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
13103                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
13104                                                 CandidateSet->empty(),
13105                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
13106     if (Recovery.isInvalid() || Recovery.isUsable())
13107       return Recovery;
13108 
13109     // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we
13110     // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to
13111     // emit better ones.
13112     for (const Expr *Arg : Args) {
13113       if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType())
13114         continue;
13115       if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
13116         auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13117         if (FD &&
13118             !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
13119                                                        Arg->getExprLoc()))
13120           return ExprError();
13121       }
13122     }
13123 
13124     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13125         PartialDiagnosticAt(
13126             Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13127             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
13128                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13129         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13130     break;
13131   }
13132 
13133   case OR_Ambiguous:
13134     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13135         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13136                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
13137                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13138         SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
13139     break;
13140 
13141   case OR_Deleted: {
13142     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13143         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13144                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
13145                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13146         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13147 
13148     // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep
13149     // the call in the AST.
13150     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13151     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13152     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13153                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13154                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13155   }
13156   }
13157 
13158   // Overload resolution failed, try to recover.
13159   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn};
13160   SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end());
13161   return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
13162                                     chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best));
13163 }
13164 
13165 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S,
13166                                                 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) {
13167   for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) {
13168     if (I->Viable &&
13169         !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) {
13170       I->Viable = false;
13171       I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available;
13172     }
13173   }
13174 }
13175 
13176 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
13177 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
13178 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
13179 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
13180 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
13181 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
13182 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13183                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13184                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13185                                          MultiExprArg Args,
13186                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13187                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
13188                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection,
13189                                          bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) {
13190   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
13191                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
13192   ExprResult result;
13193 
13194   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
13195                              &result))
13196     return result;
13197 
13198   // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that
13199   // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable.
13200   if (CalleesAddressIsTaken)
13201     markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet);
13202 
13203   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13204   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
13205       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
13206 
13207   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13208                                   ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best,
13209                                   OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection);
13210 }
13211 
13212 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
13213   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
13214          (Functions.size() == 1 &&
13215           isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
13216 }
13217 
13218 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
13219                                             NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc,
13220                                             DeclarationNameInfo DNI,
13221                                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13222                                             bool PerformADL) {
13223   return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI,
13224                                       PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns),
13225                                       Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
13226 }
13227 
13228 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13229 /// operator.
13230 ///
13231 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
13232 ///
13233 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13234 ///
13235 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13236 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13237 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13238 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13239 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13240 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
13241 ///
13242 /// \param Input The input argument.
13243 ExprResult
13244 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
13245                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13246                               Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) {
13247   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13248   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
13249   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13250   // TODO: provide better source location info.
13251   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13252 
13253   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
13254     return ExprError();
13255 
13256   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
13257   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
13258 
13259   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
13260   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
13261   // post-decrement.
13262   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
13263     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13264     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
13265                                      SourceLocation());
13266     NumArgs = 2;
13267   }
13268 
13269   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
13270 
13271   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
13272     if (Fns.empty())
13273       return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
13274                                    VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false,
13275                                    CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13276 
13277     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13278     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13279         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns);
13280     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13281       return ExprError();
13282     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray,
13283                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13284                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13285   }
13286 
13287   // Build an empty overload set.
13288   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13289 
13290   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
13291   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13292 
13293   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13294   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13295 
13296   // Add candidates from ADL.
13297   if (PerformADL) {
13298     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
13299                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
13300                                          CandidateSet);
13301   }
13302 
13303   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13304   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13305 
13306   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13307 
13308   // Perform overload resolution.
13309   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13310   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13311   case OR_Success: {
13312     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13313     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13314 
13315     if (FnDecl) {
13316       Expr *Base = nullptr;
13317       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13318       // operator.
13319 
13320       // Convert the arguments.
13321       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13322         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
13323 
13324         ExprResult InputRes =
13325           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13326                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13327         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13328           return ExprError();
13329         Base = Input = InputRes.get();
13330       } else {
13331         // Convert the arguments.
13332         ExprResult InputInit
13333           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
13334                                                       Context,
13335                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13336                                       SourceLocation(),
13337                                       Input);
13338         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
13339           return ExprError();
13340         Input = InputInit.get();
13341       }
13342 
13343       // Build the actual expression node.
13344       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
13345                                                 Base, HadMultipleCandidates,
13346                                                 OpLoc);
13347       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13348         return ExprError();
13349 
13350       // Determine the result type.
13351       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13352       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13353       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13354 
13355       Args[0] = Input;
13356       CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13357           Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13358           CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13359 
13360       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
13361         return ExprError();
13362 
13363       if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall,
13364                             FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
13365         return ExprError();
13366       return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl);
13367     } else {
13368       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13369       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13370       // operator node.
13371       ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion(
13372           Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing,
13373           CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13374       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13375         return ExprError();
13376       Input = InputRes.get();
13377       break;
13378     }
13379   }
13380 
13381   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13382     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13383     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13384     // defined too late to be candidates.
13385     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
13386       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13387       return ExprError();
13388 
13389     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
13390     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
13391     break;
13392 
13393   case OR_Ambiguous:
13394     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13395         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc,
13396                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
13397                                 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13398                                 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()),
13399         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray,
13400         UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
13401     return ExprError();
13402 
13403   case OR_Deleted:
13404     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13405         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13406                                        << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13407                                        << Input->getSourceRange()),
13408         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13409         OpLoc);
13410     return ExprError();
13411   }
13412 
13413   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
13414   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
13415   // build a built-in operation.
13416   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
13417 }
13418 
13419 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator.
13420 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
13421                                  OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
13422                                  const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13423                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) {
13424   SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation();
13425 
13426   OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp =
13427       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates
13428           ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op)
13429           : OO_None;
13430 
13431   // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the
13432   // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary.
13433   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet);
13434 
13435   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13436   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13437   if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op))
13438     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
13439                                 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13440 
13441   // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates.
13442   if (ExtraOp) {
13443     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13444     if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp))
13445       AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]},
13446                                   CandidateSet,
13447                                   OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13448   }
13449 
13450   // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not
13451   // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->,
13452   // which don't get here).
13453   if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) {
13454     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13455     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
13456                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13457                                          CandidateSet);
13458     if (ExtraOp) {
13459       DeclarationName ExtraOpName =
13460           Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp);
13461       AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args,
13462                                            /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13463                                            CandidateSet);
13464     }
13465   }
13466 
13467   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13468   //
13469   // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly
13470   // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate,
13471   // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example:
13472   //
13473   //   enum class E { e };
13474   //   bool operator!=(E, E) requires false;
13475   //   bool k = E::e != E::e;
13476   //
13477   // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But
13478   // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core
13479   // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement.
13480   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13481 }
13482 
13483 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13484 /// operator.
13485 ///
13486 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
13487 ///
13488 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13489 ///
13490 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13491 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13492 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13493 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13494 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13495 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
13496 ///
13497 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
13498 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
13499 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL.
13500 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by
13501 ///        C++20 operator rewrites.
13502 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function,
13503 ///        the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in
13504 ///        our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way
13505 ///        comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1.
13506 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
13507                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
13508                                        const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS,
13509                                        Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL,
13510                                        bool AllowRewrittenCandidates,
13511                                        FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13512   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
13513   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
13514 
13515   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
13516     AllowRewrittenCandidates = false;
13517 
13518   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13519 
13520   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13521   // expression.
13522   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13523     if (Fns.empty()) {
13524       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
13525       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
13526       if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc))
13527         return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(
13528             Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue,
13529             OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy,
13530             Context.DependentTy);
13531       return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
13532                                     Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
13533                                     OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13534     }
13535 
13536     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
13537     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13538     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
13539     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13540     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13541     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13542         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL);
13543     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13544       return ExprError();
13545     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args,
13546                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13547                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13548   }
13549 
13550   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
13551   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
13552     return ExprError();
13553 
13554   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
13555   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
13556   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
13557   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
13558     return ExprError();
13559 
13560   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
13561   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
13562   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
13563   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
13564   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
13565   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
13566   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
13567     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13568 
13569   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
13570   // create a built-in binary operator.
13571   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
13572     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13573 
13574   // Build the overload set.
13575   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
13576       OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
13577       OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates));
13578   if (DefaultedFn)
13579     CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn);
13580   LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL);
13581 
13582   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13583 
13584   // Perform overload resolution.
13585   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13586   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13587     case OR_Success: {
13588       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13589       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13590 
13591       bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed();
13592       if (IsReversed)
13593         std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]);
13594 
13595       if (FnDecl) {
13596         Expr *Base = nullptr;
13597         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13598         // operator.
13599 
13600         OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp =
13601             FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator();
13602 
13603         // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9:
13604         //   If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload
13605         //   resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool
13606         if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual &&
13607             !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) {
13608           bool IsExtension =
13609               FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
13610           Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool
13611                                   : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool)
13612               << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13613               << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13614           Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
13615           if (!IsExtension)
13616             return ExprError();
13617         }
13618 
13619         if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed &&
13620             CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) {
13621           // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some
13622           // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a
13623           // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is
13624           // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension.
13625           llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith;
13626           for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) {
13627             if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() &&
13628                 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) {
13629               for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
13630                 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
13631                         *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx],
13632                         Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) ==
13633                     ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) {
13634                   AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function);
13635                   break;
13636                 }
13637               }
13638             }
13639           }
13640 
13641           if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) {
13642             bool AmbiguousWithSelf =
13643                 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 &&
13644                 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl);
13645             Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed)
13646                 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13647                 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf
13648                 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13649             if (AmbiguousWithSelf) {
13650               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13651                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self);
13652             } else {
13653               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13654                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate);
13655               for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith)
13656                 Diag(F->getLocation(),
13657                      diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate);
13658             }
13659           }
13660         }
13661 
13662         // Convert the arguments.
13663         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13664           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
13665           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
13666 
13667           ExprResult Arg1 =
13668             PerformCopyInitialization(
13669               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13670                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13671               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13672           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13673             return ExprError();
13674 
13675           ExprResult Arg0 =
13676             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13677                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13678           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13679             return ExprError();
13680           Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13681           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13682         } else {
13683           // Convert the arguments.
13684           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
13685             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13686                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13687             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
13688           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13689             return ExprError();
13690 
13691           ExprResult Arg1 =
13692             PerformCopyInitialization(
13693               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13694                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
13695               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13696           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13697             return ExprError();
13698           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13699           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13700         }
13701 
13702         // Build the actual expression node.
13703         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
13704                                                   Best->FoundDecl, Base,
13705                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
13706         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13707           return ExprError();
13708 
13709         // Determine the result type.
13710         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13711         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13712         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13713 
13714         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13715             Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13716             CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13717 
13718         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
13719                                 FnDecl))
13720           return ExprError();
13721 
13722         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
13723         const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr;
13724         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
13725         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13726           ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0];
13727           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
13728         }
13729 
13730         // Check for a self move.
13731         if (Op == OO_Equal)
13732           DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc);
13733 
13734         checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray,
13735                   isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(),
13736                   VariadicDoesNotApply);
13737 
13738         ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
13739         if (R.isInvalid())
13740           return ExprError();
13741 
13742         R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl);
13743         if (R.isInvalid())
13744           return ExprError();
13745 
13746         // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments
13747         // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now.
13748         if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) ||
13749             (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) {
13750           if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) {
13751             assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name");
13752             R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get());
13753           } else {
13754             assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name");
13755             llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13756             Expr *ZeroLiteral =
13757                 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc);
13758 
13759             Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx;
13760             Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship;
13761             Ctx.Entity = FnDecl;
13762             pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx);
13763 
13764             R = CreateOverloadedBinOp(
13765                 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(),
13766                 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL,
13767                 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false);
13768 
13769             popCodeSynthesisContext();
13770           }
13771           if (R.isInvalid())
13772             return ExprError();
13773         } else {
13774           assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name");
13775         }
13776 
13777         // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting.
13778         if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None)
13779           R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed);
13780 
13781         return R;
13782       } else {
13783         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13784         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13785         // operator node.
13786         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13787             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
13788             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13789         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
13790           return ExprError();
13791         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
13792 
13793         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13794             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
13795             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13796         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
13797           return ExprError();
13798         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
13799         break;
13800       }
13801     }
13802 
13803     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13804       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
13805       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
13806       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
13807       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
13808       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
13809         break;
13810 
13811       // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way
13812       // compare result using '==' and '<'.
13813       if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) {
13814         ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0],
13815                                                           Args[1], DefaultedFn);
13816         if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable())
13817           return E;
13818       }
13819 
13820       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment
13821       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
13822       // no overloaded assignment operator found
13823       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
13824       StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
13825       auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
13826                                                    Args, OpLoc);
13827       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
13828           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
13829         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
13830              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13831              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13832         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
13833           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
13834             << Args[0]->getType()
13835             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13836         }
13837       } else {
13838         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13839         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13840         // defined too late to be candidates.
13841         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
13842           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13843           return ExprError();
13844 
13845         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
13846         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
13847         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13848       }
13849       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
13850              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
13851       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc);
13852       return Result;
13853     }
13854 
13855     case OR_Ambiguous:
13856       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13857           PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
13858                                          << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13859                                          << Args[0]->getType()
13860                                          << Args[1]->getType()
13861                                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13862                                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13863           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13864           OpLoc);
13865       return ExprError();
13866 
13867     case OR_Deleted:
13868       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
13869         FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function;
13870         DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD);
13871         if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) {
13872           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
13873             << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember();
13874         } else {
13875           assert(DFK.isComparison());
13876           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison)
13877             << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD;
13878         }
13879 
13880         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
13881         // explain why it's deleted.
13882         NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD);
13883         return ExprError();
13884       }
13885       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13886           PartialDiagnosticAt(
13887               OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13888                          << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName()
13889                                                     .getCXXOverloadedOperator())
13890                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13891                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13892           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13893           OpLoc);
13894       return ExprError();
13895   }
13896 
13897   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
13898   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13899 }
13900 
13901 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(
13902     SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
13903     FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13904   const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info =
13905       Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType());
13906   // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't
13907   // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this.
13908   if (!Info)
13909     return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13910 
13911   // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to
13912   // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands.
13913   assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() &&
13914          "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once");
13915   Expr *OrigLHS = LHS;
13916   Expr *OrigRHS = RHS;
13917 
13918   // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to
13919   // each of them multiple times below.
13920   LHS = new (Context)
13921       OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(),
13922                       LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS);
13923   RHS = new (Context)
13924       OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(),
13925                       RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS);
13926 
13927   ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true,
13928                                         DefaultedFn);
13929   if (Eq.isInvalid())
13930     return ExprError();
13931 
13932   ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true,
13933                                           true, DefaultedFn);
13934   if (Less.isInvalid())
13935     return ExprError();
13936 
13937   ExprResult Greater;
13938   if (Info->isPartial()) {
13939     Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true,
13940                                     DefaultedFn);
13941     if (Greater.isInvalid())
13942       return ExprError();
13943   }
13944 
13945   // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform.
13946   struct Comparison {
13947     ExprResult Cmp;
13948     ComparisonCategoryResult Result;
13949   } Comparisons[4] =
13950   { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal
13951                           : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent},
13952     {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less},
13953     {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater},
13954     {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered},
13955   };
13956 
13957   int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2;
13958 
13959   // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions.
13960   ExprResult Result;
13961   for (; I >= 0; --I) {
13962     // Build a reference to the comparison category constant.
13963     auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result);
13964     // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this?
13965     if (!VI)
13966       return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13967     ExprResult ThisResult =
13968         BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD);
13969     if (ThisResult.isInvalid())
13970       return ExprError();
13971 
13972     // Build a conditional unless this is the final case.
13973     if (Result.get()) {
13974       Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(),
13975                                   ThisResult.get(), Result.get());
13976       if (Result.isInvalid())
13977         return ExprError();
13978     } else {
13979       Result = ThisResult;
13980     }
13981   }
13982 
13983   // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to
13984   // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used.
13985   Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create(
13986       Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(),
13987       Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc,
13988       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13989   Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()};
13990   return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2);
13991 }
13992 
13993 ExprResult
13994 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
13995                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
13996                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
13997   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
13998   DeclarationName OpName =
13999       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
14000 
14001   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
14002   // expression.
14003   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
14004 
14005     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
14006     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
14007     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
14008     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
14009     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
14010         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
14011     if (Fn.isInvalid())
14012       return ExprError();
14013     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
14014 
14015     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args,
14016                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc,
14017                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14018   }
14019 
14020   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
14021   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
14022     return ExprError();
14023   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
14024     return ExprError();
14025 
14026   // Build an empty overload set.
14027   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14028 
14029   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
14030 
14031   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
14032   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
14033 
14034   // Add builtin operator candidates.
14035   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
14036 
14037   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14038 
14039   // Perform overload resolution.
14040   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14041   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
14042     case OR_Success: {
14043       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
14044       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
14045 
14046       if (FnDecl) {
14047         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
14048         // operator.
14049 
14050         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
14051 
14052         // Convert the arguments.
14053         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
14054         ExprResult Arg0 =
14055           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14056                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14057         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
14058           return ExprError();
14059         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
14060 
14061         // Convert the arguments.
14062         ExprResult InputInit
14063           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14064                                                       Context,
14065                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
14066                                       SourceLocation(),
14067                                       Args[1]);
14068         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14069           return ExprError();
14070 
14071         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14072 
14073         // Build the actual expression node.
14074         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
14075         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
14076         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
14077                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
14078                                                   Base,
14079                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
14080                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14081                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14082         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14083           return ExprError();
14084 
14085         // Determine the result type
14086         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
14087         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14088         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14089 
14090         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14091             Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
14092             CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14093         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
14094           return ExprError();
14095 
14096         if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14097                               Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14098           return ExprError();
14099 
14100         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14101       } else {
14102         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
14103         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
14104         // operator node.
14105         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14106             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
14107             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14108         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
14109           return ExprError();
14110         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
14111 
14112         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14113             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
14114             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14115         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
14116           return ExprError();
14117         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
14118 
14119         break;
14120       }
14121     }
14122 
14123     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14124       PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty()
14125           ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14126              << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
14127              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange())
14128           : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
14129              << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14130              << Args[1]->getSourceRange());
14131       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this,
14132                                   OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14133       return ExprError();
14134     }
14135 
14136     case OR_Ambiguous:
14137       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14138           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
14139                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getType()
14140                                         << Args[1]->getType()
14141                                         << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14142                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14143           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14144       return ExprError();
14145 
14146     case OR_Deleted:
14147       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14148           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14149                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14150                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14151           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14152       return ExprError();
14153     }
14154 
14155   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
14156   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
14157 }
14158 
14159 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
14160 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
14161 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
14162 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
14163 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
14164 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
14165 /// member function.
14166 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
14167                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14168                                            MultiExprArg Args,
14169                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
14170                                            bool AllowRecovery) {
14171   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
14172          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
14173 
14174   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
14175   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
14176   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
14177 
14178   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
14179   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14180     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
14181     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
14182 
14183     QualType fnType =
14184       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14185 
14186     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14187     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
14188     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
14189 
14190     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
14191     // member function we're calling.
14192     Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals();
14193 
14194     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
14195     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
14196       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14197     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
14198 
14199     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
14200     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
14201     difference.removeAddressSpace();
14202     if (difference) {
14203       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
14204       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
14205         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
14206         << qualsString
14207         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
14208     }
14209 
14210     CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14211         Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc,
14212         CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams());
14213 
14214     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(),
14215                             call, nullptr))
14216       return ExprError();
14217 
14218     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
14219       return ExprError();
14220 
14221     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
14222       return ExprError();
14223 
14224     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
14225   }
14226 
14227   // We only try to build a recovery expr at this level if we can preserve
14228   // the return type, otherwise we return ExprError() and let the caller
14229   // recover.
14230   auto BuildRecoveryExpr = [&](QualType Type) {
14231     if (!AllowRecovery)
14232       return ExprError();
14233     std::vector<Expr *> SubExprs = {MemExprE};
14234     llvm::for_each(Args, [&SubExprs](Expr *E) { SubExprs.push_back(E); });
14235     return CreateRecoveryExpr(MemExprE->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
14236                               Type);
14237   };
14238   if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr))
14239     return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue,
14240                             RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14241 
14242   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14243   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14244     return ExprError();
14245 
14246   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
14247   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
14248   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
14249   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
14250   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14251     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14252     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
14253     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
14254     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
14255     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14256   } else {
14257     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14258     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
14259 
14260     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
14261     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
14262       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
14263                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
14264 
14265     // Add overload candidates
14266     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14267                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14268 
14269     // FIXME: avoid copy.
14270     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
14271     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
14272       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
14273       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
14274     }
14275 
14276     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
14277            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
14278 
14279       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
14280       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
14281       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
14282         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
14283 
14284 
14285       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
14286       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
14287         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args,
14288                              CandidateSet,
14289                              /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false);
14290       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
14291         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
14292         // non-template member function.
14293         if (TemplateArgs)
14294           continue;
14295 
14296         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
14297                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14298                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14299       } else {
14300         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
14301             cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC,
14302             TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14303             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14304       }
14305     }
14306 
14307     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
14308 
14309     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14310 
14311     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14312     bool Succeeded = false;
14313     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14314                                             Best)) {
14315     case OR_Success:
14316       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14317       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
14318       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
14319       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14320         break;
14321       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
14322       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
14323       // called on both.
14324       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
14325       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
14326       // being used.
14327       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14328                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14329         break;
14330       Succeeded = true;
14331       break;
14332 
14333     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14334       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14335           PartialDiagnosticAt(
14336               UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14337               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14338                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14339           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14340       break;
14341     case OR_Ambiguous:
14342       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14343           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14344                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
14345                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14346           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14347       break;
14348     case OR_Deleted:
14349       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14350           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14351                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
14352                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14353           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14354       break;
14355     }
14356     // Overload resolution fails, try to recover.
14357     if (!Succeeded)
14358       return BuildRecoveryExpr(chooseRecoveryType(CandidateSet, &Best));
14359 
14360     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
14361 
14362     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
14363     // non-member call based on that function.
14364     if (Method->isStatic()) {
14365       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
14366                                    RParenLoc);
14367     }
14368 
14369     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
14370   }
14371 
14372   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
14373   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
14374   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14375 
14376   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
14377   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14378   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14379       Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc,
14380       CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams());
14381 
14382   // Check for a valid return type.
14383   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14384                           TheCall, Method))
14385     return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType);
14386 
14387   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
14388   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
14389   // it was done at lookup.
14390   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
14391     ExprResult ObjectArg =
14392       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
14393                                           FoundDecl, Method);
14394     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
14395       return ExprError();
14396     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
14397   }
14398 
14399   // Convert the rest of the arguments
14400   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
14401                               RParenLoc))
14402     return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType);
14403 
14404   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14405 
14406   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14407     return ExprError();
14408 
14409   // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading
14410   // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do
14411   // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors.
14412   if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14413     if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr =
14414             CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) {
14415       Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(),
14416            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14417           << Method << Method->getSourceRange();
14418       Diag(Method->getLocation(),
14419            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
14420           << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
14421       return ExprError();
14422     }
14423   }
14424 
14425   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
14426        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
14427       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
14428     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
14429 
14430     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) &&
14431         MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
14432       Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14433            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
14434           << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
14435           << MD->getParent();
14436 
14437       Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
14438       if (getLangOpts().AppleKext)
14439         Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext)
14440             << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName();
14441     }
14442   }
14443 
14444   if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD =
14445           dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) {
14446     // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode.
14447     bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext;
14448     CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false,
14449                          CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true,
14450                          MemExpr->getMemberLoc());
14451   }
14452 
14453   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall),
14454                                      TheCall->getMethodDecl());
14455 }
14456 
14457 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
14458 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
14459 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
14460 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
14461 ExprResult
14462 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
14463                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14464                                    MultiExprArg Args,
14465                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
14466   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
14467     return ExprError();
14468   ExprResult Object = Obj;
14469 
14470   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14471   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14472     return ExprError();
14473 
14474   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14475          "Requires object type argument");
14476 
14477   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
14478   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
14479   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
14480   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
14481   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
14482   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
14483   //  (E).operator().
14484   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
14485                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14486   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
14487 
14488   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
14489                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
14490     return true;
14491 
14492   const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>();
14493   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14494   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
14495   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14496 
14497   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14498        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14499     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
14500                        Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet,
14501                        /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14502   }
14503 
14504   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
14505   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
14506   //   declared in T of the form
14507   //
14508   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
14509   //
14510   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
14511   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
14512   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
14513   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
14514   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
14515   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
14516   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
14517   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
14518   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
14519   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
14520   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
14521   const auto &Conversions =
14522       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
14523   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
14524     NamedDecl *D = *I;
14525     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
14526     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
14527       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
14528 
14529     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
14530     // surrogates.
14531     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14532       continue;
14533 
14534     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
14535     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
14536       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
14537       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
14538       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
14539       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
14540         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
14541 
14542       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14543       {
14544         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
14545                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
14546       }
14547     }
14548   }
14549 
14550   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14551 
14552   // Perform overload resolution.
14553   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14554   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14555                                           Best)) {
14556   case OR_Success:
14557     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
14558     // below.
14559     break;
14560 
14561   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14562     PartialDiagnostic PD =
14563         CandidateSet.empty()
14564             ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14565                << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
14566                << Object.get()->getSourceRange())
14567             : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
14568                << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange());
14569     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14570         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this,
14571         OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14572     break;
14573   }
14574   case OR_Ambiguous:
14575     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14576         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14577                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
14578                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14579                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14580         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14581     break;
14582 
14583   case OR_Deleted:
14584     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14585         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14586                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
14587                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14588                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14589         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14590     break;
14591   }
14592 
14593   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
14594     return true;
14595 
14596   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14597 
14598   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
14599     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
14600     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
14601     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
14602       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
14603                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
14604 
14605     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
14606                               Best->FoundDecl);
14607     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
14608       return ExprError();
14609     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14610              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
14611     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
14612     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
14613     // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job.
14614 
14615     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
14616     // and then call it.
14617     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
14618                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
14619     if (Call.isInvalid())
14620       return ExprError();
14621     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
14622     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
14623         Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
14624         nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14625 
14626     return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
14627   }
14628 
14629   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14630 
14631   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
14632   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
14633   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
14634   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14635 
14636   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
14637   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
14638     return ExprError();
14639 
14640   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14641   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
14642 
14643   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
14644                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
14645   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
14646   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14647                                            Obj, HadMultipleCandidates,
14648                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14649                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14650   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
14651     return true;
14652 
14653   // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default
14654   // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally
14655   // need one more slot for the object parameter.
14656   unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams);
14657 
14658   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
14659   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
14660   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots);
14661 
14662   bool IsError = false;
14663 
14664   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
14665   ExprResult ObjRes =
14666     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14667                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14668   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
14669     IsError = true;
14670   else
14671     Object = ObjRes;
14672   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
14673 
14674   // Check the argument types.
14675   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
14676     Expr *Arg;
14677     if (i < Args.size()) {
14678       Arg = Args[i];
14679 
14680       // Pass the argument.
14681 
14682       ExprResult InputInit
14683         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14684                                                     Context,
14685                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
14686                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
14687 
14688       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
14689       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14690     } else {
14691       ExprResult DefArg
14692         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
14693       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
14694         IsError = true;
14695         break;
14696       }
14697 
14698       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
14699     }
14700 
14701     MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg;
14702   }
14703 
14704   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
14705   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
14706     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
14707     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
14708       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
14709                                                         nullptr);
14710       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
14711       MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get();
14712     }
14713   }
14714 
14715   if (IsError)
14716     return true;
14717 
14718   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14719 
14720   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned.
14721   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14722   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14723   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14724 
14725   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14726       Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc,
14727       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14728 
14729   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
14730     return true;
14731 
14732   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14733     return true;
14734 
14735   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method);
14736 }
14737 
14738 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
14739 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
14740 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
14741 ExprResult
14742 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
14743                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14744   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14745          "left-hand side must have class type");
14746 
14747   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
14748     return ExprError();
14749 
14750   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
14751 
14752   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
14753   //
14754   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
14755   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
14756   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
14757   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
14758   DeclarationName OpName =
14759     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
14760   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14761 
14762   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
14763                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
14764     return ExprError();
14765 
14766   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14767   LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
14768   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14769 
14770   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14771        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14772     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
14773                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14774   }
14775 
14776   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14777 
14778   // Perform overload resolution.
14779   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14780   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
14781   case OR_Success:
14782     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
14783     break;
14784 
14785   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14786     auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14787     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
14788       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
14789       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14790         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
14791         // diagnostic, as requested.
14792         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
14793         return ExprError();
14794       }
14795       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
14796         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
14797       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
14798         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
14799           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
14800       }
14801     } else
14802       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
14803         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
14804     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands);
14805     return ExprError();
14806   }
14807   case OR_Ambiguous:
14808     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14809         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
14810                                        << "->" << Base->getType()
14811                                        << Base->getSourceRange()),
14812         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base);
14813     return ExprError();
14814 
14815   case OR_Deleted:
14816     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14817         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14818                                        << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()),
14819         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14820     return ExprError();
14821   }
14822 
14823   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14824 
14825   // Convert the object parameter.
14826   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14827   ExprResult BaseResult =
14828     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14829                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14830   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
14831     return ExprError();
14832   Base = BaseResult.get();
14833 
14834   // Build the operator call.
14835   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14836                                             Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
14837   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14838     return ExprError();
14839 
14840   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14841   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14842   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14843   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
14844       CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base,
14845                                   ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14846 
14847   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
14848     return ExprError();
14849 
14850   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14851                         Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14852     return ExprError();
14853 
14854   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14855 }
14856 
14857 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
14858 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
14859 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
14860                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
14861                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
14862                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
14863                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
14864   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
14865 
14866   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
14867                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14868   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet,
14869                                  TemplateArgs);
14870 
14871   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14872 
14873   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
14874   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
14875   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14876   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
14877   case OR_Success:
14878   case OR_Deleted:
14879     break;
14880 
14881   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14882     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14883         PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc,
14884                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
14885                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14886         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14887     return ExprError();
14888 
14889   case OR_Ambiguous:
14890     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14891         PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
14892                                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14893         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14894     return ExprError();
14895   }
14896 
14897   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
14898   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
14899                                         nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates,
14900                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
14901                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
14902   if (Fn.isInvalid())
14903     return true;
14904 
14905   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
14906   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
14907   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
14908   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
14909     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
14910       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
14911       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
14912     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14913       return true;
14914     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
14915   }
14916 
14917   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
14918   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14919   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14920 
14921   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create(
14922       Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy,
14923       VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14924 
14925   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
14926     return ExprError();
14927 
14928   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
14929     return ExprError();
14930 
14931   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD);
14932 }
14933 
14934 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
14935 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
14936 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
14937 /// dependent lookup.
14938 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
14939 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
14940 /// is returned.
14941 Sema::ForRangeStatus
14942 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc,
14943                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
14944                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
14945                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
14946                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
14947                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
14948   Scope *S = nullptr;
14949 
14950   CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14951   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
14952     ExprResult MemberRef =
14953         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
14954                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
14955                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
14956                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
14957                                  MemberLookup,
14958                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
14959     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
14960       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14961       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14962     }
14963     *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
14964     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
14965       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14966       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14967     }
14968   } else {
14969     ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
14970                                                 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
14971                                                 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
14972     if (FnR.isInvalid())
14973       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14974     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get());
14975 
14976     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
14977                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
14978     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
14979       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14980       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14981     }
14982     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14983     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
14984         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
14985 
14986     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
14987       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14988       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14989     }
14990     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
14991                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
14992                                          OverloadResult,
14993                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
14994     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
14995       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14996       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14997     }
14998   }
14999   return FRS_Success;
15000 }
15001 
15002 
15003 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
15004 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
15005 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
15006 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
15007 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
15008 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
15009                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
15010   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
15011     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
15012                                                    Found, Fn);
15013     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
15014       return PE;
15015 
15016     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
15017   }
15018 
15019   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
15020     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
15021                                                    Found, Fn);
15022     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
15023                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
15024            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
15025     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
15026     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
15027       return ICE;
15028 
15029     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(),
15030                                     SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(),
15031                                     CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15032   }
15033 
15034   if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) {
15035     if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) {
15036       Expr *SubExpr =
15037           FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn);
15038       if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr())
15039         return GSE;
15040 
15041       // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic
15042       // selection expression.
15043       ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs();
15044       SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end());
15045       unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex();
15046       AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr;
15047 
15048       return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
15049           Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(),
15050           GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
15051           GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(),
15052           ResultIdx);
15053     }
15054     // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic
15055     // selection expression.
15056     return GSE;
15057   }
15058 
15059   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
15060     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
15061            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
15062     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
15063       if (Method->isStatic()) {
15064         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
15065         // from non-member functions.
15066       } else {
15067         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
15068         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
15069         // or template.
15070         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15071                                                        Found, Fn);
15072         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15073           return UnOp;
15074 
15075         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
15076                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
15077         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
15078                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
15079 
15080         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
15081         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
15082         // appropriate pointer to member type.
15083         QualType ClassType
15084           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
15085         QualType MemPtrType
15086           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
15087         // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
15088         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
15089           (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType);
15090 
15091         return UnaryOperator::Create(
15092             Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
15093             UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15094       }
15095     }
15096     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15097                                                    Found, Fn);
15098     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15099       return UnOp;
15100 
15101     return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
15102                                  Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
15103                                  VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(),
15104                                  false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15105   }
15106 
15107   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
15108     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15109     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15110     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15111       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15112       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15113     }
15114 
15115     DeclRefExpr *DRE =
15116         BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(),
15117                          ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15118                          ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15119     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
15120     return DRE;
15121   }
15122 
15123   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
15124     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15125     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15126     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15127       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15128       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15129     }
15130 
15131     Expr *Base;
15132 
15133     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
15134     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
15135     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
15136       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15137         DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr(
15138             Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(),
15139             MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15140             MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15141         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
15142         return DRE;
15143       } else {
15144         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
15145         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
15146           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
15147         Base =
15148             BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true);
15149       }
15150     } else
15151       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
15152 
15153     ExprValueKind valueKind;
15154     QualType type;
15155     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15156       valueKind = VK_LValue;
15157       type = Fn->getType();
15158     } else {
15159       valueKind = VK_RValue;
15160       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
15161     }
15162 
15163     return BuildMemberExpr(
15164         Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(),
15165         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found,
15166         /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
15167         type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs);
15168   }
15169 
15170   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
15171 }
15172 
15173 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
15174                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
15175                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
15176   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
15177 }
15178